2022 Compass
2022 Compass
2022 Compass
Whether it’s providing information about specific product features, taking a tour through your vehicle’s heritage, knowing what
steps to take following an accident or scheduling your next appointment, we know you’ll find the app an important extension of
your Jeep® brand vehicle. Simply download the app, select your make and model and enjoy the ride. To get this app, go directly
to the App Store® or Google Play® Store and enter the search keyword “JEEP” (U.S. residents only). OW NE R’ S M ANUAL
2 02 2 CO M PASS
U. S. Canada
mopar.com/om owners.mopar.ca
©2021 FCA US LLC. All Rights Reserved. Tous droits réservés. Jeep is a registered trademark of FCA US LLC. Jeep est une Second Edition
marque déposée de FCA US LLC. App Store is a registered trademark of Apple Inc. Google Play Store is a registered trademark of Google. 22_MP_OM_EN_USC
This Owner’s Manual illustrates and describes the operation of features and equipment that are either standard or optional on this The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe operation of the vehicle. Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control,
vehicle. This manual may also include a description of features and equipment that are no longer available or were not ordered on resulting in an accident and personal injury. FCA US LLC strongly recommends that the driver use extreme caution when using any device
this vehicle. Please disregard any features and equipment described in this manual that are not on this vehicle. FCA US LLC reserves the or feature that may take their attention off the road. Use of any electrical devices, such as cellular telephones, computers, portable radios,
right to make changes in design and specifications, and/or make additions to or improvements to its products without imposing any vehicle navigation or other devices, by the driver while the vehicle is moving is dangerous and could lead to a serious accident. Texting
obligation upon itself to install them on products previously manufactured. while driving is also dangerous and should never be done while the vehicle is moving. If you find yourself unable to devote your full
With respect to any vehicles sold in Canada, the name FCA US LLC shall be deemed to be deleted and the name FCA Canada Inc. attention to vehicle operation, pull off the road to a safe location and stop your vehicle. Some states or provinces prohibit the use of
used in substitution therefore. cellular telephones or texting while driving. It is always the driver’s responsibility to comply with all local laws.
This Owner’s Manual is intended to familiarize you with the important features of your vehicle. Your most up-to-date Owner’s Manual, This Owner’s Manual has been prepared to help you get acquainted with your new Jeep® brand vehicle and to provide a convenient
Navigation/Uconnect manuals and Warranty Booklet can be found by visiting the website on the back cover. reference source for common questions.
U.S. Residents: If you are the first registered retail owner of your vehicle, you may obtain a complimentary printed copy of the Warranty Not all features shown in this manual may apply to your vehicle. For additional information, visit mopar.com/om (U.S.), owners.mopar.ca
Booklet by calling 1-877-426-5337 or by contacting your dealer. Replacement kits can be purchased by visiting www.techauthority.com. (Canada) or your local Jeep® brand dealer.
Canadian Residents: If you are the first registered retail owner of your vehicle, you may obtain a complimentary printed copy of the
Warranty Booklet or purchase a replacement kit by calling 1-800-387-1143 or by contacting your dealer.
DRIVING AND ALCOHOL
Drunk driving is one of the most frequent causes of accidents. Your driving ability can be seriously impaired with blood alcohol levels
WARNING: Operating, servicing and maintaining a passenger vehicle or off-highway far below the legal minimum. If you are drinking, don’t drive. Ride with a designated non-drinking driver, call a cab, a rideshare, a friend
motor vehicle can expose you to chemicals including engine exhaust, carbon monoxide, or use public transportation.
phthalates, and lead, which are known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth
defects or other reproductive harm. To minimize exposure, avoid breathing exhaust,
do not idle the engine except as necessary, service your vehicle in a well-ventilated area WARNING
and wear gloves or wash your hands frequently when servicing your vehicle. For more Driving after drinking can lead to an accident. Your perceptions are less sharp, your reflexes are slower and your judgment is impaired
information go to www.P65Warnings.ca.gov/passenger-vehicle. when you have been drinking. Never drink and then drive.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 1
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1 INTRODUCTION .............................................................................................................................. 8 1
5 MULTIMEDIA ...............................................................................................................................164 5
WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES ................... 89 ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS ....... 102 CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEMS —
Red Warning Lights ..........................................89 PARK BRAKE ....................................................... 103 IF EQUIPPED ........................................................116
Yellow Warning Lights ......................................92 Electric Park Brake (EPB) ............................ 103 Cruise Control................................................ 117
Yellow Indicator Lights .....................................96 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ............................. 106 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) ...................... 118
Green Indicator Lights......................................96 Ignition Park Interlock................................... 107 TRAFFIC SIGN ASSIST SYSTEM —
White Indicator Lights ......................................97 Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock (BTSI) IF EQUIPPED.........................................................127
Blue Indicator Lights ........................................97 System ........................................................... 107 Activation/Deactivation ................................ 127
Gray Indicator Lights ........................................98 6-Speed Or 9-Speed Automatic Traffic Sign Assist Modes ............................. 127
ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD II ....... 98 Transmission ................................................ 107 Indications On The Display ........................... 128
Onboard Diagnostic System (OBD II) FOUR-WHEEL DRIVE OPERATION — HIGHWAY ASSIST SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED .....129
Cybersecurity ....................................................98 IF EQUIPPED ........................................................ 112 Operation....................................................... 129
EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Jeep® Active Drive ........................................ 112 Turning Highway Assist On Or Off................. 130
PROGRAMS ............................................................ 99 SELEC-TERRAIN — IF EQUIPPED ....................... 113 Indications On The Display ........................... 131
Mode Selection Guide................................... 113 System Status ............................................... 132
STARTING AND OPERATING POWER STEERING .............................................. 114 System Operation/Limitations ..................... 132
STARTING THE ENGINE.......................................100 STOP/START SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED............. 114 PARKSENSE FRONT/REAR PARK ASSIST
Normal Starting ............................................. 100 Autostop Mode .............................................. 114 SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED .....................................133
Cold Weather Operation Possible Reasons The Engine Does ParkSense Sensors....................................... 133
(Below –22°F Or −30°C) ............................ 101 Not Autostop.................................................. 115 ParkSense Warning Display ......................... 133
Extended Park Starting ................................. 101 To Start The Engine While In Autostop ParkSense Display ........................................ 133
After Starting — Warming Up The Engine..... 101 Mode .............................................................. 115 Enabling And Disabling ParkSense.............. 136
If Engine Fails To Start ................................. 101 To Manually Turn Off The Stop/Start Service The ParkSense Park Assist
Stopping The Engine ..................................... 102 System ........................................................... 116 System ........................................................... 137
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER — IF EQUIPPED .........102 To Manually Turn On The Stop/Start Cleaning The ParkSense System ................. 137
System ........................................................... 116 ParkSense System Usage Precautions........ 137
System Malfunction ...................................... 116 Side Distance Warning (SDW) System......... 138
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 5
INTRODUCTION
Dear Customer,
Congratulations on the purchase of your new Jeep® vehicle. Be assured that it represents precision workmanship, distinctive styling, and high quality.
This Owner's Manual has been prepared with the assistance of service and engineering specialists to acquaint you with the operation and maintenance of your
vehicle. It is supplemented by customer-oriented documents. Within this information, you will find a description of the services that FCA US LLC offers to its
customers as well as the details of the terms and conditions for maintaining its validity. Please take the time to read these publications carefully. Following the
instructions and recommendations in this manual will help ensure safe and enjoyable operation of your vehicle.
This Owner’s Manual describes all versions of this vehicle. Options and equipment dedicated to specific markets or versions are not expressly indicated in the
text. Therefore, you should only consider the information that is related to the trim level, engine, and version that you have purchased. Any content introduced
throughout the Owner’s Information, which may or may not be applicable to your vehicle, will be identified with the wording “If Equipped”. All data contained in
this publication are intended to help you use your vehicle in the best possible way. FCA US LLC reserves the right to make changes to the model described for
technical and/or commercial reasons. For further information, contact an authorized dealer.
When it comes to service, remember that authorized dealers know your Jeep® best, have factory-trained technicians and genuine Mopar® parts, and care about
your satisfaction.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 9
SYMBOLS KEY gravity than many passenger vehicles. It is capable of performing better in a
wide variety of off-road applications. Driven in an unsafe manner, all vehicles
These statements are against operating can go out of control. Because of the higher center of gravity, if this vehicle is
WARNING! procedures that could result in a collision, bodily out of control it may roll over while some other vehicles may not. 1
injury and/or death. Do not attempt sharp turns, abrupt maneuvers, or other unsafe driving actions
These statements are against procedures that that can cause loss of vehicle control. Failure to operate this vehicle safely may
CAUTION!
could result in damage to your vehicle. result in a collision, rollover of the vehicle, and severe or fatal injury. Drive
A suggestion which will improve installation, carefully.
NOTE: operation, and reliability. If not followed, may
result in damage.
General ideas/solutions/suggestions on easier
TIP:
use of the product or functionality.
PAGE REFERENCE
ARROW
Follow this reference for additional information on
a particular feature.
ROLLOVER WARNING
Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than other types of
vehicles. This vehicle has a higher ground clearance and a higher center of
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 10
10
11
Oil Temperature Warning Light Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Active Warning Light 1
Ú page 92 Ú page 93
Seat Belt Reminder Warning Light Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF Warning Light
Ú page 92 Ú page 93
Vehicle Security Warning Light Service Active Lane Management Warning Light
Ú page 92 Ú page 93
12
Engine Check/Malfunction Indicator (MIL) Warning Light 4WD Lock Indicator Light
Ú page 93 Ú page 96
13
14
NOTE: The vehicle’s horn will rapidly chirp three times Key Fob:
In case the ignition switch does not change with along with a single flash of the vehicle’s exterior 1. Remove the emergency key (2) by sliding the
the push of a button, the key fob may have a low or lights. emergency key release (1) on the back of the
fully depleted battery. A low key fob battery can be NOTE: key fob and pulling the emergency key out
verified by referring to the instrument cluster, with your other hand.
The doors have to be open and then closed in
which will display directions to follow Ú page 328.
order for the vehicle to check for the presence of 2
To Unlock/Lock The Doors And Liftgate a key fob; the Key Left Vehicle feature will not
Push and release the unlock button on the key fob activate until all of the doors are closed.
once to unlock the driver’s door. If selected within These alerts will not be activated in situations
Uconnect Settings, pushing the unlock button where the vehicle’s engine is left running with
twice within five seconds will unlock all the doors the key fob inside.
and the liftgate. To lock all the doors and the
liftgate, push the lock button once Ú page 165. Replacing The Battery In The Key Fob
When the doors are unlocked, the turn signals will The replacement battery is one CR2032 battery.
flash and the illuminated entry system will be NOTE:
activated. When the doors are locked, the turn Customers are recommended to use a battery Emergency Key Removal
signals will flash and the horn will chirp. obtained from Mopar®. Aftermarket coin
Key Left Vehicle Feature battery dimensions may not meet the original 1 — Emergency Key Release
OEM coin battery dimensions. 2 — Emergency Key
If a valid key fob is no longer detected inside the
vehicle while the vehicle’s ignition system is in the Perchlorate Material — special handling may
ON/RUN or START position, the message “Key Left apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazard-
Vehicle” will be shown in the instrument cluster ouswaste/perchlorate for further information.
display along with an interior chime. An exterior Do not touch the battery terminals that are on
audible and visual alert will also be activated to the back housing or the printed circuit board.
warn the driver.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 16
2. Separate the key fob halves using a #2 flat 3. Remove the back cover to access and replace Programming And Requesting Additional
blade screwdriver or a coin, and gently pry the the battery. When replacing the battery, match Key Fobs
two halves of the key fob apart. Make sure not the (+) sign on the battery to the (+) sign on the
to damage the seal during removal. inside of the battery clip, located on the back Programming the key fob may be performed by an
cover. Avoid touching the new battery with your authorized dealer.
fingers. Skin oils may cause battery deterio- NOTE:
ration. If you touch a battery, clean it with Once a key fob is programmed to a vehicle, it
rubbing alcohol. cannot be repurposed and reprogrammed to
4. To assemble the key fob case, snap the two another vehicle.
halves together. Only key fobs that are programmed to the
vehicle electronics can be used to start and
WARNING! operate the vehicle. Once a key fob is
programmed to a vehicle, it cannot be
The integrated key fob contains a coin cell programmed to any other vehicle.
battery. Do not ingest the battery; there is a
Separating Case With A Coin chemical burn hazard. If the coin cell battery is WARNING!
swallowed, it can cause severe internal burns
in just two hours and can lead to death. Always remove the key fobs from the vehicle
and lock all doors when leaving the vehicle
If you think a battery may have been swal- unattended.
lowed or placed inside any part of the body,
seek immediate medical attention. For vehicles equipped with Keyless
Enter ‘n Go™ Ignition, always remember to
Keep new and used batteries away from place the ignition in the OFF position.
children. If the battery compartment does not
close securely, stop using the product and
keep it away from children.
REMOTE START — IF EQUIPPED HOW TO USE R EMOTE S TART All of the following conditions must be met before
the engine will remote start:
This system uses the key fob to start the Push and release the Remote Start button on the
Gear selector in PARK
engine conveniently from outside the key fob twice within five seconds. The vehicle
vehicle while still maintaining security. doors will lock, the parking lights will flash, and the Doors closed
The system has a range of approximately horn will chirp twice (if programmed). Then, the Hood closed 2
328 ft (100 m). engine will start, and the vehicle will remain in the
Liftgate closed
Remote Start mode for a 15 minute cycle. Pushing
Remote Start is used to defrost windows in cold Hazard switch off
the Remote Start button a third time shuts the
weather and to reach a comfortable climate in all
engine off. Brake switch inactive (brake pedal not pressed)
ambient conditions before the customer enters the
vehicle. To drive the vehicle, push the unlock button and Battery at an acceptable charge level
place the ignition in the ON/RUN position.
NOTE: PANIC button not pushed
Obstructions between the vehicle and key fob may NOTE: System not disabled from previous Remote
reduce this range Ú page 328. With Remote Start, the engine will only run for Start event
15 minutes.
WARNING! Vehicle Security Light flashing (if equipped)
Remote Start can only be used twice.
Ignition in the OFF position
Do not start or run an engine in a closed
If an engine fault is present or fuel level is low,
garage or confined area. Exhaust gas contains Fuel level meets minimum requirement
the vehicle will start and then shut down in
Carbon Monoxide (CO) which is odorless and 10 seconds. Vehicle Security system is not signaling an intru-
colorless. Carbon Monoxide is poisonous and sion
can cause serious injury or death when The parking lights will turn on and remain on
during Remote Start mode. Malfunction Indicator Light is not illuminated
inhaled.
For security, power window and power sunroof
Keep key fobs away from children. Operation WARNING!
operation (if equipped) are disabled when the
of the Remote Start system, windows, door
vehicle is in the Remote Start mode. Do not start or run an engine in a closed garage
locks or other controls could cause serious
or confined area. Exhaust gas contains Carbon
injury or death. The ignition must be placed in the ON/RUN posi-
Monoxide (CO) which is odorless and colorless.
tion before the Remote Start sequence can be
Carbon Monoxide is poisonous and can cause
repeated for a third cycle.
serious injury or death when inhaled.
(Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 20
adjusted by the driver while the vehicle is in Remote Remote Start Aborted — Time Expired The Vehicle Security system does not monitor
Start mode. This includes turning the climate Remote Start Disabled — Start Vehicle To Reset glass breakage or the movement of objects or
controls off using the OFF button. people inside the vehicle. The alarm does not
The message will stay active until the ignition is intervene in the case of vehicle tilt variations
REMOTE START W INDSHIELD W IPER placed in the ON/RUN position. when it is parked.
DE–ICER ACTIVATION — I F EQUIPPED 2
VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED TO ARM THE SYSTEM
When Remote Start is active and the outside
ambient temperature is less than 33°F (0.6°C), The Vehicle Security system monitors the vehicle Follow these steps to arm the Vehicle Security
the Windshield Wiper De-Icer will activate. Exiting doors, hood, liftgate, and the Keyless Enter ‘n Go™ system:
Remote Start will resume its previous operation. If Ignition for unauthorized operation. While the 1. Make sure the vehicle’s ignition is placed in
the Windshield Wiper De-Icer was active, the timer Vehicle Security system is armed, interior switches the OFF position.
and operation will continue. for door locks and liftgate release are disabled. If
For vehicles equipped with Keyless Entry,
something triggers the system, the Vehicle Security
REMOTE START A BORT M ESSAGE — system will provide the following audible and make sure the vehicle’s keyless ignition
visible signals: system is OFF.
I F EQUIPPED 2. Perform one of the following methods to lock
The horn will pulse
The following messages will display in the the vehicle:
instrument cluster display if the vehicle fails to The turn signals will flash
Push the lock button on the interior power
remote start or exits Remote Start prematurely: The Vehicle Security Light in the instrument door lock switch with the driver and/or
Remote Start Aborted — Door Open cluster will flash passenger door open.
Remote Start Aborted — Hood Open NOTE: Push the lock button on the exterior Passive
Remote Start Aborted — Fuel Low The Vehicle Security system is factory adjusted Entry door handle with a valid key fob avail-
to standards from different countries. able in the same exterior zone Ú page 23.
Remote Start Aborted — Liftgate Open
The Vehicle Security system is a complementary Push the lock button on the key fob.
Remote Start Disabled — Start Vehicle To Reset security system developed to hinder the occur- 3. If any doors are open, close them.
Remote Start Aborted — Too Cold rence of vehicle theft and prevent vandalism. It
does not prevent the theft of your vehicle; the When the Vehicle Security system is armed, the
system is a deterrent. Vehicle Security Light (located in the lower left
portion of the instrument cluster display) will begin
to flash every three seconds until it is disarmed.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 22
NOTE:
If the system is armed by pushing the lock button
The Vehicle Security system is designed to protect
your vehicle. However, you can create conditions
DOORS
on the interior door panel, the Vehicle Security where the system will give you a false alarm. If one MANUAL D OOR L OCKS
Light will flash rapidly for about 15 seconds once of the previously described arming sequences has
the door is closed, then slow down to every three occurred, the Vehicle Security system will arm The door locks can be manually locked from inside
seconds. regardless of whether you are in the vehicle or not. the vehicle by using the door lock knob.
If you remain in the vehicle and open a door, the
TO DISARM T HE S YSTEM alarm will sound. If this occurs, disarm the Vehicle
The Vehicle Security system can be disarmed using Security system.
any of the following methods: If the Vehicle Security system is armed and the
Push the unlock button on the key fob. battery becomes disconnected, the Vehicle
Security system will remain armed when the
Grab the Passive Entry door handle to unlock
battery is reconnected; the exterior lights will flash,
the door Ú page 23. and the horn will sound. If this occurs, disarm the
Cycle the ignition out of the OFF position to Vehicle Security system.
disarm the system.
REARMING O F T HE SYSTEM
NOTE:
Manual Door Lock Knob
The driver's door key cylinder and the liftgate If something triggers the alarm, and no action is
button on the key fob cannot arm or disarm the taken to disarm it, the Vehicle Security system will To lock each door, rotate the door lock knob on
Vehicle Security system. turn the horn off after approximately 90 seconds, each door trim panel forward until the lock
and then the Vehicle Security system will rearm indicator is shown. To unlock the front doors, pull
The Vehicle Security system remains armed
itself. the inside door handle to the first detent or rotate
during power liftgate entry. Pushing the liftgate
the door lock button until the lock indicator is
button will not disarm the Vehicle Security SECURITY S YSTEM MANUAL O VERRIDE hidden. To unlock the rear doors, rotate the door
system. If someone enters the vehicle through
The Vehicle Security system will not arm if you lock lock button until the lock indicator is hidden. If the
the liftgate and opens any door, the alarm will
the doors using the manual door lock. door lock button is locked (lock indicator visible)
sound.
when you shut the door, the door will remain
When the Vehicle Security system is armed, the locked. Therefore, make sure the key fob is not
interior power door lock switches will not unlock inside the vehicle before closing the door.
the doors.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 23
NOTE: If you push the power door lock switch while the
WARNING! ignition is in the ON/RUN position, and any door or
Manually locking the vehicle will not arm the
Vehicle Security system. Do not leave the key fob in or near the vehicle, the liftgate is open, the power locks will not
or in a location accessible to children. Do not operate. This prevents you from accidentally
The manual door locks will not lock or unlock the
leave the Keyless Enter ‘n Go™ Ignition in the locking the key fob in the vehicle. Placing the
liftgate.
ON/RUN position. A child could operate power ignition in the OFF position or closing the doors and 2
windows, other controls, or move the vehicle. liftgate will allow the locks to operate.
WARNING!
For personal security and safety in the event
KEYLESS ENTER ‘N GO™ — PASSIVE
of a collision, lock the vehicle doors before you POWER D OOR L OCKS E NTRY
drive as well as when you park and exit the The power door lock switches are located on each
vehicle. The Passive Entry system is an enhancement to
front door panel. Push the switch to lock or unlock the vehicle’s Remote Keyless Entry system and a
When exiting the vehicle, always remove the the doors and liftgate. feature of Keyless Enter ‘n Go™ — Passive Entry.
key fob from the vehicle and lock your vehicle. This feature allows you to lock and unlock the
If equipped with a Keyless Enter ‘n Go™ Igni- vehicle’s door(s) without having to push the key fob
tion, always make sure the keyless ignition is lock or unlock buttons.
in the OFF position, remove the key fob from
NOTE:
the vehicle and lock the vehicle. Unsupervised
use of vehicle equipment may cause severe Passive Entry may be programmed on/off
personal injuries or death. through Uconnect Settings Ú page 165.
The key fob may not detect the Passive Entry
Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or
system if it is located next to a mobile phone,
with access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing
laptop or other electronic device; these devices
children to be in a vehicle unattended is
may block the key fob’s wireless signal and
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
Power Door Lock Switch prevent the Passive Entry system from locking
others could be seriously or fatally injured.
and unlocking the vehicle.
Children should be warned not to touch the
parking brake, brake pedal or the gear
selector.
(Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 24
If wearing gloves, or if it has been raining/ All doors and the liftgate will unlock when the front The doors are manually locked using the door
snowing on the Passive Entry door handle, the passenger door handle is grabbed regardless of lock knobs.
unlock sensitivity can be affected, resulting in a the driver’s door unlock preference setting. Three attempts are made to lock the doors
slower response time. Frequency Operated Button Integrated Key using the door panel switch and then the doors
If the vehicle is unlocked by Passive Entry and (FOBIK-Safe) are closed.
no door is opened within 60 seconds, the To minimize the possibility of unintentionally There is a valid Passive Entry key fob outside the
vehicle will relock and, if equipped, will arm the locking a Passive Entry key fob inside your vehicle, vehicle and within 5 ft (1.5 m) of either Passive
Vehicle Security system. the Passive Entry system is equipped with an Entry door handle.
To Unlock From The Driver's Side Or Passenger’s automatic door unlock feature which will function if To Lock The Vehicle’s Doors And Liftgate
Side the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
With one of the vehicle’s Passive Entry key fobs
With a valid Passive Entry key fob within 5 ft There are three situations that trigger a within 5 ft (1.5 m) of either front door handle, push
(1.5 m) of either front door handle, grab the door FOBIK-Safe search in any Passive Entry vehicle: the Passive Entry lock button located on the
handle to unlock the door automatically. A lock request is made by a valid Passive Entry outside door handle to lock the vehicle doors and
key fob while a door is open. liftgate.
A lock request is made by the Passive Entry door
handle while a door is open.
A lock request is made by the door panel switch
while the door is open.
When any of these situations occur, after all open
doors are shut, the FOBIK-Safe search will be
executed. If it detects a Passive Entry key fob
inside the vehicle and it does not detect any
Passive Entry key fobs outside the vehicle, then the
Grab The Door Handle To Unlock vehicle will unlock and alert the customer.
Either the driver door only or all doors will unlock NOTE: Push The Door Handle Button To Lock
when you grab hold of the front driver’s door The vehicle will only unlock the doors when a valid
handle, depending on the selected setting in the Passive Entry key fob is detected inside the
Uconnect system Ú page 165. vehicle. The vehicle will not unlock the doors when
any of the following conditions are true:
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 25
WARNING!
Avoid trapping anyone in a vehicle in a collision.
Remember that the rear doors can only be
opened from the outside when the
Child-Protection locks are engaged (locked).
NOTE:
Always use this device when carrying children.
After engaging the child lock on both rear doors,
Child-Protection Door Lock Function check for effective engagement by trying to open a Tilt/Telescoping Lever
NOTE: door with the internal handle. Once the To unlock the steering column, push the control
Child-Protection Door Lock system is engaged, it is handle downward (toward the floor). To tilt the
When the Child-Protection Door Lock system is impossible to open the doors from inside the
engaged, the door can be opened only by using steering column, move the steering wheel upward
vehicle. Before getting out of the vehicle, be sure to or downward as desired. To lengthen or shorten
the outside door handle even though the inside check that there is no one left inside.
door lock is in the unlocked position. the steering column, pull the steering wheel
outward or push it inward as desired. To lock the
After disengaging the Child-Protection Door STEERING WHEEL steering column in position, push the control
Lock system, always test the door from the handle upward until fully engaged.
inside to make certain it is in the desired posi- TILT/TELESCOPING STEERING COLUMN
tion. WARNING!
This feature allows you to tilt the steering column
After engaging the Child-Protection Door Lock
upward or downward. It also allows you to lengthen Do not adjust the steering column while driving.
system, always test the door from the inside to or shorten the steering column. The tilt/ Adjusting the steering column while driving or
make certain it is in the desired position. telescoping lever is located below the steering driving with the steering column unlocked, could
For emergency exit with the system engaged, wheel at the end of the steering column. cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle.
rotate the door lock button until the lock indi- Failure to follow this warning may result in
cator is hidden (unlocked position), roll down serious injury or death.
the window, and open the door with the outside
door handle.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 27
PROGRAMMING T HE M EMORY FEATURE NOTE: To recall the memory settings for driver one or two,
Before programming your key fob you must select push the desired memory button number (1 or 2)
To create a new memory profile, perform the the “Memory Linked To FOB” feature through the or the unlock button on the key fob linked to the
following: Uconnect Settings Ú page 165. desired memory position.
NOTE: To program your key fob, perform the following: A recall can be canceled by pushing any of the
Saving a new memory profile will erase an existing 1. Place the vehicle’s ignition in the OFF memory buttons (S, 1, or 2) during a recall. When
profile from memory. position. a recall is canceled, the driver seat will stop
1. Place the vehicle’s ignition in the ON position. moving. A delay of one second will occur before
2. Select the desired memory profile (1) or (2). another recall can be selected.
2. Adjust all memory profile settings to desired
3. Push and release the set (S) button on the
preferences (i.e., seat and radio station
presets).
memory switch, then within five seconds push
and release the button labeled (1) or (2)
SEATS
3. Push the set (S) button on the memory switch, accordingly. “Memory Profile Set” (1 or 2) will Seats are a part of the Occupant Restraint system
and then push the desired memory button display in the instrument cluster display. of the vehicle.
(1 or 2) within five seconds. The instrument
4. Push and release the lock button on the key WARNING!
cluster display will display which memory
fob within 10 seconds.
position is being set. It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside
NOTE: or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people
NOTE:
Your key fob can be unlinked from your memory riding in these areas are more likely to be seri-
Memory profiles can be set without the vehicle in
settings by pushing the set (S) button, followed by ously injured or killed.
PARK, but the vehicle must be in PARK to recall a
pushing the unlock button on the key fob within
memory profile. Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
10 seconds.
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and
LINKING AND UNLINKING THE REMOTE MEMORY POSITION R ECALL seat belts. In a collision, people riding in these
KEYLESS ENTRY KEY F OB T O M EMORY areas are more likely to be seriously injured or
NOTE: killed.
Your remote keyless entry key fob can be The vehicle must be in PARK to recall memory posi-
programmed to recall one of two saved memory tions. If a recall is attempted when the vehicle is Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat
profiles. not in PARK, a message will display in the and using a seat belt properly.
instrument cluster display.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 29
MANUAL A DJUSTMENT (FRONT S EATS) — While sitting in the seat, lift up on the bar and move Manual Seat Height Adjustment —
the seat forward or rearward. Release the bar once If Equipped
I F E QUIPPED you have reached the desired position. Then, using
body pressure, move forward and rearward on the The driver’s seat height can be raised or lowered
Manual Front Seat Forward/Rearward by using a lever, located on the outboard side of
seat to be sure that the seat adjusters have
Adjustment the seat. Pull upward on the lever to raise the seat
latched.
height or push downward on the lever to lower the 2
Some models may be equipped with manual front
seats. The seats can be adjusted forward or WARNING! seat height.
rearward by using a bar located by the front of the
seat cushion, near the floor. Adjusting a seat while driving may be
dangerous. Moving a seat while driving could
result in loss of control which could cause a
collision and serious injury or death.
Seats should be adjusted before fastening the
seat belts and while the vehicle is parked.
Serious injury or death could result from a
poorly adjusted seat belt.
Manual Front Seat Recline Adjustment Fold-Forward Front Passenger Seat — MANUAL A DJUSTMENT (REAR SEATS)
To adjust the seatback, lift the lever located on the If Equipped
outboard side of the seat, lean back to the desired This feature allows for extended cargo space. WARNING!
position and release the lever. To return the When the seat is folded flat, it is an extension of Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than the top
seatback, lift the lever, lean forward and release the load floor surface (allowing long cargo to fit of the seatback. This could impair visibility or
the lever. from the rear hatch up to the instrument panel). become a dangerous projectile in a sudden stop
The fold-forward seatback has a softback surface or collision.
that you can use as a work surface when the seat
is folded forward and the vehicle is not in motion.
60/40 Split Folding Rear Seat With
Pull upward on the recline lever to fold or unfold
the seat. Fold-Flat Feature
NOTE: To provide additional storage area, each rear seat
You may experience deformation in the seat can be folded flat. This allows for extended cargo
cushion from the seat belt buckles if the seats are space and still maintains some rear seating room.
left folded for an extended period of time. This is NOTE:
normal and by simply unfolding the seats to the Prior to folding the rear seat, it may be necessary
Recline Lever open position, over time the seat cushion will to position the front seat to its mid-track position.
return to its normal shape. Also, be sure that the front seats are fully upright
and positioned forward. This will allow the rear seat
WARNING! WARNING! to fold down easily.
Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that Adjusting a seat while the vehicle is moving is
the shoulder belt is no longer resting against dangerous. The sudden movement of the seat
your chest. In a collision you could slide under could cause you to lose control. Adjust any seat
the seat belt, which could result in serious injury only while the vehicle is parked.
or death.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 31
WARNING!
Illuminated Vanity Mirror Cover
Vehicles and other objects seen in the
Sun Visor “Slide-On-Rod” Feature — passenger side convex mirror will look smaller
If Equipped and farther away than they really are. Relying too
The sun visor “Slide-On-Rod” feature allows for much on your passenger side convex mirror
additional flexibility in positioning the sun visor to could cause you to collide with another vehicle
block out the sun. or other object. Use your inside mirror when
Automatic Dimming Button judging the size or distance of a vehicle seen in
1. Fold down the sun visor.
the passenger side convex mirror.
2. Unclip the visor from the center clip.
CAUTION!
3. Pivot the sun visor toward the side window.
To avoid damage to the mirror during cleaning,
never spray any cleaning solution directly onto 4. Extend the sun visor for additional sun
the mirror. Apply the solution onto a clean cloth blockage.
and wipe the mirror clean.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 39
UNIVERSAL GARAGE DOOR OPENER To operate HomeLink®, push and release any
of the programmed HomeLink® buttons. These
Ensure that your vehicle is parked outside of the
garage before you begin programming.
(HOMELINK®) — IF EQUIPPED buttons will activate the devices they are It is recommended that you erase all the channels
programmed to with each press of the corre- of your HomeLink® before you use it for the first
sponding HomeLink® button. time.
The HomeLink® indicator light is located above
the center button. ERASING ALL THE H OMELINK®
The HomeLink® buttons, located on the driver’s C HANNELS
side sun visor, designate the three different To erase the channels, follow this procedure:
HomeLink® channels. The HomeLink® indicator is
located above the center button. 1. Place the ignition switch into the ON/RUN
position.
NOTE:
2. Push and hold the two outside HomeLink®
HomeLink® is disabled when the Vehicle Security
buttons (I and III) for up to 20 seconds, or until
system is active Ú page 328.
HomeLink® Buttons On Sun Visor the HomeLink® indicator light flashes.
Use this QR code to access your
BEFORE YOU BEGIN PROGRAMMING
NOTE:
digital experience. HOMELINK® Erasing all channels should only be performed
For efficient programming and accurate when programming HomeLink® for the first time.
HomeLink® replaces up to
transmission of the radio-frequency signal, it is Do not erase channels when programming addi-
three hand-held transmitters
recommended that a new battery be placed in the tional buttons.
that operate devices such as
garage door openers, motor- hand-held transmitter of the device that is being
ized gates, lighting, or home programmed to the HomeLink® system. Make
security systems. The HomeLink® unit is sure your hand-held transmitter is programmed to
powered by your vehicle’s 12 Volt battery. activate the device you are trying to program your
HomeLink® button to.
The HomeLink® buttons that are located in the
overhead console or sunvisor designate the
three different HomeLink® channels.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 41
Non-Rolling Code Garage Door Opener Final Steps PROGRAMMING H OMELINK® TO A 1. Place the ignition in the ON/RUN position,
without starting the engine.
1. Push and hold the programmed HomeLink® MISCELLANEOUS D EVICE
button and observe the HomeLink® indicator 2. Push and hold the desired HomeLink® button
light. If the HomeLink® indicator light stays The procedure on how to program HomeLink® to a until the HomeLink® Indicator light begins to
on constantly, programming is complete. miscellaneous device follows the same procedure flash after 20 seconds. Do not release the
as programming to a garage door opener button.
2. Push the programmed HomeLink® button to
Ú page 165. Be sure to determine if the device has
confirm that the garage door opener motor 3. Without releasing the button, proceed with
a rolling code, or non-rolling code before beginning
operates. If the garage door opener motor Step 2 in “Programming HomeLink® To A
the programming process.
does not operate, repeat the steps from the Garage Door Opener” and follow all remaining
beginning. NOTE: steps.
Canadian radio frequency laws require transmitter
WARNING!
signals to time-out (or quit) after several seconds CANADIAN/GATE OPERATOR
of transmission, which may not be long enough for
Your motorized door or gate will open and HomeLink® to pick up the signal during
P ROGRAMMING
close while you are programming the universal programming. Similar to this Canadian law, some For programming transmitters in Canada/United
transceiver. Do not program the transceiver if US gate operators are designed to time-out in the States that require the transmitter signals to
people or pets are in the path of the door or same manner. The procedure may need to be “time-out” after several seconds of transmission.
gate. performed multiple times to successfully pair the
Canadian radio frequency laws require transmitter
device to your HomeLink® buttons.
Do not run your vehicle in a closed garage or signals to time-out (or quit) after several seconds
confined area while programming the trans- REPROGRAMMING A S INGLE of transmission – which may not be long enough
ceiver. Exhaust gas from your vehicle contains for HomeLink® to pick up the signal during
Carbon Monoxide (CO) which is odorless and
HOMELINK® B UTTON programming. Similar to this Canadian law, some
colorless. Carbon Monoxide is poisonous To reprogram a single HomeLink® button that has US gate operators are designed to time-out in the
when inhaled and can cause you and others to been previously trained, without erasing all the same manner.
be severely injured or killed. channels, follow the procedure below. Be sure to
determine whether the new device you want to
program the HomeLink® button to has a Rolling
Code, or Non-rolling Code.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 43
It may be helpful to unplug the device during the 5. Press and hold the programmed HomeLink® 3. Without releasing the button, proceed with
cycling process to prevent possible overheating of button and observe the indicator light. “Canadian/Gate Operator Programming”
the garage door or gate motor. NOTE: Step 2 and follow all remaining steps.
1. Place the ignition in the ON/RUN position. If the indicator light stays on constantly,
2. Place the hand-held transmitter 1 to 3 inches programming is complete and the garage EXTERIOR LIGHTS
(3 to 8 cm) away from the HomeLink® button door/device should activate when the 2
you wish to program while keeping the HomeLink® button is pressed. MULTIFUNCTION L EVER
HomeLink® indicator light in view. To program the two remaining HomeLink®
3. Continue to press and hold the HomeLink® buttons, repeat each step for each
button, while you press and release (cycle) remaining button. DO NOT erase the
your hand-held transmitter every two seconds channels.
until HomeLink® has successfully accepted
the frequency signal. The indicator light will If you unplugged the garage door opener/device
flash slowly and then rapidly when fully for programming, plug it back in at this time. Multifunction Lever
trained. Reprogramming A Single HomeLink® Button The multifunction lever controls the operation of
4. Watch for the HomeLink® indicator to change (Canadian/Gate Operator) the turn signals, headlight beam selection and
flash rates. When it changes, it is To reprogram a channel that has been previously passing lights. The multifunction lever is located on
programmed. It may take up to 30 seconds or trained, follow these steps: the left side of the steering column.
longer in rare cases. The garage door may
1. Place the ignition in the ON/RUN position.
open and close while you are programming.
2. Press and hold the desired HomeLink® button
until the indicator light begins to flash after
20 seconds. Do not release the button.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 44
Rotate the headlight switch clockwise to the first HIGH/LOW B EAM SWITCH
Headlight Switch detent for parking lights and instrument panel
Push the multifunction lever toward the instrument
lights operation. Rotate the headlight switch to the
1 — Rotate Headlight Control panel to switch the headlights to high beams.
second detent for headlights, parking lights and
2 — Front Fog Light Switch Pulling the multifunction lever back will turn the
instrument panel lights operation.
low beams on.
3 — Ambient Lighting Control (If Equipped) NOTE:
4 — Instrument Panel Dimmer Control For vehicles sold in Canada, rotate the headlight
switch clockwise from the parking lights and
instrument panel lights position to the first detent
for headlights, parking lights and instrument panel
lights operation. Rotate the headlight switch to the
second detent for the AUTO position.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 45
AUTOMATIC HIGH B EAM HEADLAMP AUTOMATIC HEADLIGHTS — I F EQUIPPED Headlight delay can be cancelled by either turning
the headlights or parking lights on, or placing the
CONTROL — I F EQUIPPED This system automatically turns the headlights on ignition in the ON/RUN position.
The Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control or off according to ambient light levels. To turn the
If you turn the headlights off before the ignition,
system provides increased forward lighting at night system on, rotate the headlight switch clockwise to
they will turn off in the normal manner.
the last detent for automatic headlight operation.
by automating high beam control through the use
NOTE: 2
of a digital camera mounted on the windshield. When the system is on, the headlight time delay
This camera detects vehicle specific light and feature is also on. This means the headlights will The lights must be turned off within 45 seconds
automatically switches from high beams to low stay on for up to 90 seconds after you place the of placing the ignition in the OFF position to acti-
beams until the approaching vehicle is out of view. ignition into the OFF position. To turn the vate this feature. If the headlight switch is in the
automatic system off, move the headlight switch AUTO position prior to placing the ignition in the
NOTE: out of the AUTO position. OFF position, there is no need to turn the head-
The Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control light switch to off to activate Headlight Delay.
NOTE:
can be turned on or off through Uconnect
The engine must be running before the headlights The headlight delay timing is programmable
Settings Ú page 165.
will come on in the automatic mode. through Uconnect Settings Ú page 165.
Broken, muddy, or obstructed headlights and
taillights of vehicles in the field of view will HEADLIGHT TIME D ELAY LIGHTS-O N R EMINDER
cause headlights to remain on longer (closer to To assist when exiting the vehicle, the headlight If the headlights or parking lights are on after the
the vehicle). Also, dirt, film, and other obstruc- delay feature will leave the headlights on for up to ignition is in the OFF position, a chime will sound to
tions on the windshield or camera lens will 90 seconds. alert the driver when the driver's door is opened.
cause the system to function improperly.
To activate the delay feature, place the ignition in
FLASH-TO-P ASS the OFF position while the headlights are still on.
Then, turn off the headlights within 45 seconds.
You can signal another vehicle with your headlights The delay interval begins when the headlight
by lightly pulling the multifunction lever toward you. switch is turned off.
This will cause the high beam headlights to turn on,
and remain on, until the lever is released.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 46
FOG LIGHTS — I F EQUIPPED To activate the front fog lights, turn on the parking LANE CHANGE ASSIST
lights or the low beam headlights and push the fog
The front fog light switch is built into the headlight light button. To turn off the front fog lights, either Lightly push the multifunction lever up or down,
switch. push the fog lights button a second time or turn off without moving beyond the detent, and the turn
the headlight switch. signal will flash five times then automatically turn
off.
An indicator light in the instrument cluster
illuminates when the fog lights are turned on. BATTERY SAVER F EATURE
NOTE: To protect the battery, the interior lights will turn off
The fog lights will operate with the low beam head- automatically 15 minutes after the ignition switch
lights or parking lights on. However, selecting the is placed in the OFF position. This will occur if the
high beam headlights will turn off the fog lights. interior lights were switched on manually or are on
TURN SIGNALS because a door is open.
Rotating the instrument panel dimmer up or down Ambient Light Control — If Equipped
will adjust the brightness of the instrument panel
Rotate the ambient dimmer control upward or
lights ONLY when the parking lights or headlights
downward to increase or decrease the brightness
are turned on, AND ONLY if the built in light sensor
of the ambient light located in the overhead
determines that the ambient light levels are low
console, door handle lights, lights under the
enough that the backlighting should be enabled.
instrument panel, door map pocket lights, and 2
cubby bin lights.
Ambient lights are only enabled when the
headlights are active.
Overhead Light Switches
To protect the battery, the interior lights will turn off
automatically 15 minutes after the ignition is
placed in the OFF position. This will occur if the
interior lights were turned on manually or are on
because a door is open. This includes the glove
compartment light and the cargo area light. To Instrument Panel Dimmer
restore interior light operation, either place the
ignition in the ON/RUN position, or push the light
switch on and then back off.
Ambient Light Dimmer
Instrument Panel Dimmer Control
The instrument panel dimmer control is part of the
headlight switch and is located on the driver’s side
of the instrument panel.
Mist Use of Rain-X or products containing wax or sili- REAR WINDOW W IPER/WASHER
Push the lever upward to the MIST position and cone may reduce Rain Sensing performance.
The rear wiper/washer controls are located on the
release for a single wiping cycle. The Rain Sensing feature can be turned on and
windshield wiper/washer lever on the right side of
NOTE: off through Uconnect Settings Ú page 165.
the steering column. The rear wiper/washer is
The mist feature does not activate the washer The Rain Sensing system has protection features operated by rotating a switch, located at the
pump; therefore, no washer fluid will be sprayed on for the wiper blades and arms, and will not operate 2
middle of the lever.
the windshield. The wash function must be used in under the following conditions:
The rear wiper/washer controls are located on the
order to spray the windshield with washer fluid. Change In Ignition Position — If the vehicle is in windshield wiper/washer lever on the right side of
For information on wiper care and replacement, Rain Sensing mode and the ignition is cycled the steering column. The rear wiper has different
see Ú page 275. from OFF to ON, the auto wiper will be operation modes:
suppressed until vehicle speed is greater than
RAIN S ENSING WIPERS — IF EQUIPPED 3 mph (5 km/h), or the wiper switch is moved
Intermittent mode
out of and back into the Intermittent wipe posi- Synchronous mode (at half speed of the front
This feature senses rain or snow fall on the
windshield and automatically activates the wipers. tion. window wiper) when the front window wiper is
Rotate the end of the multifunction lever to one of operating
Transmission In NEUTRAL Position — The Rain
two detent positions to activate this feature. Sensing system will not operate if the NEUTRAL Continuous mode
The sensitivity of the system can be adjusted with gear is selected at speeds of 3 mph (5 km/h) or Vehicle in REVERSE: If the front wiper is active
the multifunction lever. Wiper delay position one is less unless the wiper switch is moved or the and the REVERSE gear is selected, the wiper will
the least sensitive, and wiper delay position two is gear selector is moved out of NEUTRAL. turn on for one wipe
the most sensitive. Place the wiper switch in the Remote Start Mode Inhibit — On vehicles Rotate the center portion of the lever
O (off) position when not using the system. equipped with the Remote Start system, Rain upward to the first detent for intermittent
NOTE: Sensing wipers are not operational when the operation and to the second detent for
vehicle is in Remote Start mode. Once the oper- continuous rear wiper operation.
The Rain Sensing feature will not operate when
ator is in the vehicle and has placed the ignition To use the washer, push the lever
the wiper switch is in the low or high-speed posi-
switch in the ON/RUN position, Rain Sensing forward and hold while spray is desired.
tion.
wiper operation can resume, if it has been If the lever is pushed while the wiper is in
The Rain Sensing feature may not function prop- selected, and no other inhibit conditions
erly when ice, or dried salt water is present on the off position, the wiper will operate for
(mentioned previously) exist. several wipe cycles, then turn off.
the windshield.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 50
If the lever is pushed while in the intermittent Activation By Remote Start Operation (If Climate Controls
setting, the wiper will turn on and operate for Equipped) — When Remote Start is active and
several wipe cycles after the end of the lever is the outside ambient temperature is less than
released, and then resume the intermittent 33°F (0.6°C), the Windshield Wiper De-Icer will
interval previously selected. be enabled. Exiting Remote Start will resume its
NOTE: previous operation. If the Windshield Wiper
As a protective measure, the pump will stop if the De-Icer was active, the timer and operation will
switch is held for more than 20 to 30 seconds. continue.
Once the lever is released the pump will resume
normal operation. CLIMATE CONTROLS
WINDSHIELD WIPER D E-ICER — The Climate Control system allows you to regulate
the temperature, air flow, and direction of air
I F EQUIPPED circulating throughout the vehicle. The controls are
Uconnect 5 With 10.1-inch Display Automatic
located on the touchscreen (if equipped) and on Climate Controls
Your vehicle may be equipped with a Windshield
Wiper De-Icer feature that may be activated under the instrument panel below the radio. MAX A/C Button
the following conditions: AUTOMATIC CLIMATE CONTROL Press and release the MAX A/C button on
Activation By Front Defrost — The Windshield
DESCRIPTIONS AND F UNCTIONS the touchscreen to change the current
Wiper De-Icer shall be activated automatically in setting to the coldest output of air. The
the case of a cold weather manual start with full MAX A/C indicator illuminates when MAX
front defrost, and when the ambient tempera- A/C is on. Pressing the button again will cause the
ture is below 33°F (0.6°C). MAX A/C operation to exit. Pressing other settings
Activation By Rear Defrost — The Windshield will cause the MAX A/C to exit.
Wiper De-Icer shall be activated automatically NOTE:
when the rear defrost is turned on and when the The MAX A/C button is only available on the touch-
ambient temperature is below 33°F (0.6°C). screen.
A/C Button (button on the touchscreen grayed out) if Front Defrost Button
conditions exist that could create fogging on
Press and release the A/C button on Press and release the touchscreen
the inside of the windshield. The A/C can be
the touchscreen, or push the button on button, or push and release the button
deselected manually without disturbing the
the faceplate to change the current on the faceplate, to change the current
mode control selection. Continuous use of the
setting. The A/C indicator illuminates airflow setting to Defrost mode. The Front
when A/C is ON.
Recirculation mode may make the inside air stuffy
Defrost indicator illuminates when Front Defrost is 2
and window fogging may occur. Extended use of
The Air Conditioning (A/C) button allows the on. Air comes from the windshield and side window
this mode is not recommended.
operator to manually activate or deactivate the air demist outlets. When the defrost button is
conditioning system. When the air conditioning NOTE: selected, the blower level may increase. Use
system is turned on, dehumidified air will flow After 25 minutes of continuous use, Recircula- Defrost mode with maximum temperature settings
through the outlets into the cabin. tion mode will automatically shut off for two for best windshield and side window defrosting
minutes to allow fresh air intake inside the and defogging. When toggling the front defrost
If your air conditioning performance seems lower mode button, the Climate Control system will
cabin to maintain sufficient oxygen levels.
than expected, check the front of the A/C return to the previous setting.
condenser (located in front of the radiator), for an Recirculation mode will function in this way, in
accumulation of dirt or insects. Clean with a gentle either automatic or manual override mode. Rear Defrost Button
water spray from the front of the radiator and AUTO Button Press and release the button on the
through the condenser. If the problem persists, touchscreen, or push and release the
please contact an authorized dealer. Press and release this button on the
button on the faceplate, to turn on the
touchscreen, or push the button on the
Recirculation Button rear window defroster and the heated
faceplate, to change the current setting.
outside mirrors (if equipped). The Rear Defrost
Press and release this button on the The AUTO indicator illuminates when
indicator illuminates when the rear window
touchscreen, or push the button on the AUTO is on. This feature automatically controls the
defroster is on. The rear window defroster
faceplate, to change the system between interior cabin temperature by adjusting distribution
automatically turns off after 10 minutes.
recirculation mode and outside air mode. and amount of airflow. Toggling this function will
The Recirculation indicator and the A/C indicator cause the system to switch between manual
illuminate when the Recirculation button is override mode and automatic modes Ú page 56.
pressed. Recirculation can be used when outside
conditions such as smoke, odors, dust, or high
humidity are present. Recirculation can be used in
all modes. Recirculation may be unavailable
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 52
A/C Button fogging on the inside of the windshield. The A/C Rear Defrost Button
can be deselected manually without disturbing the
Push the A/C button to engage the Air Press and release the button on the
mode control selection. Continuous use of the
Conditioning (A/C). The A/C indicator touchscreen, or push and release the
Recirculation mode may make the inside air stuffy
illuminates when A/C is on. button on the faceplate, to turn on the
and window fogging may occur. Extended use of
NOTE: rear window defroster and the heated
this mode is not recommended.
outside mirrors (if equipped). The Rear Defrost
For Manual Climate Controls, if the system is in On systems with Manual Climate Controls, if indicator illuminates when the rear window
Mix, Floor or Defrost Mode, the A/C can be equipped, the Recirculation mode is not allowed in defroster is on. The rear window defroster
turned off, but the A/C system shall remain Defrost mode to improve window clearing automatically turns off after 10 minutes.
active to prevent fogging of the windows. operation. Recirculation is disabled automatically
If fog or mist appears on the windshield or side if this mode is selected. Attempting to use CAUTION!
glass, select Defrost mode, and increase blower Recirculation while in this mode causes the LED in
Failure to follow these cautions can cause
speed if needed. the control button to blink and then turns off.
damage to the heating elements:
If your air conditioning performance seems Front Defrost Setting
lower than expected, check the front of the A/C Use care when washing the inside of the rear
Press and release the touchscreen window. Do not use abrasive window cleaners
condenser (located in front of the radiator), for
button, or push and release the button on the interior surface of the window. Use a
an accumulation of dirt or insects. Clean with a
on the faceplate, to change the current soft cloth and a mild washing solution, wiping
gentle water spray from the front of the radiator
airflow setting to Defrost mode. The Front parallel to the heating elements. Labels can
and through the condenser.
Defrost indicator illuminates when Front Defrost is be peeled off after soaking with warm water.
Recirculation Button on. Air comes from the windshield and side window
demist outlets. When the defrost button is Do not use scrapers, sharp instruments, or
Push the Recirculation button to change abrasive window cleaners on the interior
the system between recirculation mode selected, the blower level may increase. Use
Defrost mode with maximum temperature settings surface of the window.
and outside air mode. The Recirculation
indicator and the A/C indicator illuminate for best windshield and side window defrosting Keep all objects a safe distance from the
when the Recirculation button is pressed. and defogging. When toggling the front defrost window.
Recirculation can be used when outside mode button, the Climate Control system will
conditions, such as smoke, odors, dust, or return to the previous setting.
humidity are present. Recirculation can be used in
all modes except for Defrost. Recirculation may be
unavailable if conditions exist that could create
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 55
Climate Control OFF NOTE: Did You Know: Voice Command for Climate may
It is not necessary to move the temperature only be used to adjust the interior temperature of
Press and release this button on the
settings for cold or hot vehicles. The system your vehicle. Voice Command will not work to
touchscreen, or push and release the
automatically adjusts the temperature, mode, adjust the heated seats or steering wheel if
button on the faceplate to turn the
and blower speed to provide comfort as quickly equipped.
Climate Control ON/OFF.
as possible. OPERATING T IPS
AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL The temperature can be displayed in US or
(ATC) Metric units by selecting the US/Metric Refer to the chart at the end of this section for
customer-programmable feature. suggested control settings for various weather
Automatic Operation conditions.
To provide you with maximum comfort in the
1. Push the AUTO button on the faceplate, or the Summer Operation
Automatic mode during cold start-ups, the blower
AUTO button on the touchscreen (if equipped)
fan remains on low until the engine warms up. The engine cooling system must be protected with
on the Automatic Temperature Control (ATC)
The blower increases in speed and transition into a high-quality antifreeze coolant to provide proper
Panel.
Auto mode. corrosion protection and to protect against engine
2. Next, adjust the temperature you would like the overheating. OAT coolant (conforming to
system to maintain by adjusting the Manual Operation Override
MS.90032) is recommended.
temperature control buttons. Once the desired This system offers a full complement of manual
temperature is displayed, the system achieves override features. The AUTO symbol in the front Winter Operation
and automatically maintains that comfort level. ATC display will be turned off when the system is To ensure the best possible heater and defroster
3. When the system is set up for your comfort being used in the manual mode. performance, make sure the engine cooling
system is functioning properly and the proper
level, it is not necessary to change the CLIMATE VOICE COMMANDS amount, type, and concentration of coolant is
settings. You experience the greatest
efficiency by simply allowing the system to Adjust vehicle temperatures hands-free and keep used. Use of the Air Recirculation mode during
function automatically. everyone comfortable while you keep moving ahead. Winter months is not recommended, because it
may cause window fogging.
Push the VR button on the steering wheel. After the
beep, say one of the following commands: Vacation/Storage
“Set the driver temperature to 70 degrees” For information on maintaining the Climate Control
“Set the passenger temperature to 70 degrees”
system when the vehicle is being stored for an
extended period of time, see Ú page 315.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 57
INTERIOR STORAGE AND EQUIPMENT Console Storage Compartment Plugging in a smartphone device to a USB port will
activate Android Auto™ or Apple CarPlay®
To open, pull up on the latch and lift the cover.
STORAGE features, if equipped. For further information, refer
to “Android Auto™” or “Apple CarPlay®” in the
Glove Compartment Owner’s Manual Supplement.
The glove compartment is located on the NOTE:
passenger side of the instrument panel. Two devices can be plugged in at the same time,
and both ports will provide charging capabilities.
Only one port can transfer data to the system at a
time.
For example, if a device is plugged into the Type A
USB port and another device is plugged into the
Type C USB port, a message will appear and allow
Center Console you to select which device to use.
The center console has a storage area which can Different scenarios are listed below when a
hold cell phones, PDAs, and other small items. The non-phone device is plugged into the smaller and
center console can slide forward and rearward for larger USB ports, and when a phone device is
comfort. plugged into the smaller and larger USB ports:
Glove Compartment
“A new device is now connected.
To open the glove compartment, pull the release WARNING! Previous connection was lost”.
handle.
Do not operate this vehicle with a console “(Phone Name) now connected.
compartment lid in the open position. Driving Previous connection was lost”.
WARNING!
with the console compartment lid open may “Another device is in use through the same
Do not operate this vehicle with a glove result in injury in a collision. USB port. Please disconnect the first device to
compartment in the open position. Driving with use the second device”.
the glove compartment open may result in injury USB C ONTROL
in a collision.
This feature allows an external USB device to be
plugged into one of the USB ports, located in the
center stack of the instrument panel.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 59
Plugging in a phone or another USB device may NOTE: POWER O UTLETS — IF EQUIPPED
cause the connection to a previous device to be Depending on track configuration, track infor-
lost. mation may not be present on the radio display. Your vehicle may be equipped with 12 Volt
(13 Amp) power outlets that can be used to power
The device can be controlled using the radio
cellular phones, small electronics and other low
buttons to play, and browse the contents of the
powered electrical accessories. The power outlets
device. 2
are labeled with either a key or a battery symbol to
The audio device battery charges when plugged indicate how the outlet is powered. Power outlets
into the USB port. labeled with a key are powered when the ignition is
The second row USB ports can be used to charge in the ON/RUN position, while the outlets labeled
an external device. with a battery are connected directly to the battery
and powered at all times.
NOTE:
All accessories connected to the battery powered
Front USB Ports outlets should be removed or turned off when the
vehicle is not in use to protect the battery against
1 — Type C USB Port
discharge.
2 — Type A USB Port
CAUTION!
By using a USB cable to connect an external Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs
device: only. Do not insert any other object in the power
The device can be played on the vehicle’s sound outlets as this will damage the outlet and blow
Charge Only Rear USB Ports
system, providing the artist, track title, and the fuse. Improper use of the power outlet can
album information on the radio display. NOTE: cause damage not covered by your New Vehicle
Charge unsupported devices with the Charge Only Limited Warranty.
USB ports. If an unsupported device is plugged into
a Media USB port, a message will display on the
touchscreen that the device is not supported by
the system.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 60
Only devices designed for use in this type of After the use of high power draw accessories,
outlet should be inserted into any 12 Volt or long periods of the vehicle not being started
outlet. (with accessories still plugged in), the vehicle
must be driven a sufficient length of time to
Do not touch with wet hands. allow the generator to recharge the vehicle's
Close the lid when not in use and while driving battery.
Front Power Outlet
the vehicle.
If equipped, a power outlet is located in the rear
cargo area.
If this outlet is mishandled, it may cause an POWER I NVERTER — IF E QUIPPED
electric shock and failure.
There is a 115 Volt, 150 Watt inverter outlet
located on the back of the center console to
convert DC current to AC current. This outlet can
CAUTION! power cellular phones, electronics and other low
Many accessories that can be plugged in draw power devices requiring power up to 150 Watts.
power from the vehicle's battery, even when Certain game consoles will exceed this power limit,
not in use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.). Eventu- as will most power tools.
ally, if plugged in long enough, the vehicle's
battery will discharge sufficiently to degrade
battery life and/or prevent the engine from
starting.
Rear Cargo Area Power Outlet — If Equipped (Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 61
CAUTION!
The passenger door windows can also be operated AUTOMATIC WINDOW F EATURES
by using the single window controls on each
The key fob should not be placed on the passenger door trim panel. The window controls Auto-Down Feature
charging pad or within 6 inches (15 cm) of it. will operate only when the ignition is in the The driver and front passenger door power window
Doing so can cause excessive heat buildup and ON/RUN position. switches have an Auto-Down feature. Push the
damage to the fob. Placing the fob in close To open the window part way, push the window window switch down for a short period of time,
proximity of the charging pad blocks the fob from switch down briefly and release it when you want then release, and the window will go down
being detected by the vehicle and prevents the the window to stop. automatically.
vehicle from starting. To stop the window from going all the way down
NOTE:
The power window switches will remain active for during the Auto-Down operation, pull up or push
WINDOWS up to 10 minutes after the ignition is placed in the
OFF position. Opening either front door will cancel
the switch briefly.
Auto-Up Feature With Anti-Pinch Protection
POWER W INDOW CONTROLS this feature. Lift the window switch up for a short period of time
The timing is programmable within Uconnect and release; the window will go up automatically.
The window controls on the driver's door control all
Settings Ú page 165.
the door windows. To stop the window from going all the way up
during the Auto-Up operation, push down or pull
WARNING!
the switch briefly.
Never leave children unattended in a vehicle. To close the window part way, lift the window
Do not leave the key fob in or near the vehicle or switch briefly and release it when you want the
in a location accessible to children, and do not window to stop.
leave the ignition of a vehicle equipped with
Keyless ‘n Go™ in the ON/RUN position. If the window runs into any obstacle during
Occupants, particularly unattended children, auto-closure, it will reverse direction and then go
can become entrapped by the windows while back down. Remove the obstacle and use the
operating the power window switches. Such window switch again to close the window.
entrapment may result in serious injury or death. NOTE:
Power Window Controls Any impact due to rough road conditions may
trigger the auto-reverse function unexpectedly
during auto-closure. If this happens, pull the switch
lightly and hold to close the window manually.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 63
WARNING!
on). To enable the window controls, push and
release the window lockout switch again (the
POWER SUNROOF WITH POWER SHADE —
There is no anti-pinch protection when the indicator light on the switch will turn off). IF EQUIPPED
window is almost closed. To avoid personal
The power sunroof switches are located between
injury be sure to clear your arms, hands, fingers
the sun visors on the overhead console.
and all objects from the window path before 2
closing.
RESET A UTO-U P
Should the Auto-Up feature stop working, the
window probably needs to be reset. To reset
Auto-Up:
1. Pull the window switch up to close the window
Window Lockout Switch
completely and continue to hold the switch up
for an additional two seconds after the WIND B UFFETING
window is closed. Power Sunroof Switches
2. Push the window switch down firmly to open Wind buffeting can be described as the perception
of pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound 1 — Power Shade Switch
the window completely and continue to hold
in the ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting 2 — Front Panel Open/Close Switch
the switch down for an additional two seconds
after the window is fully open. with the windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) 3 — Front Panel Vent Switch
in certain open or partially open positions. This is a
normal occurrence and can be minimized. If the
WINDOW L OCKOUT SWITCH buffeting occurs with the rear windows open, open
The window lockout switch on the driver's door trim the front and rear windows together to minimize
panel allows you to disable the window controls on the buffeting. If the buffeting occurs with the
the rear passenger doors. To disable the window sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to
controls, push and release the window lockout minimize the buffeting or open any window.
switch (the indicator light on the switch will turn
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 64
OPENING A ND CLOSING THE POWER During Express Open or Express Close operation, PINCH PROTECT F EATURE
any movement of the sunshade switch will stop the
SUNSHADE shade. This feature will detect an obstruction in the
The sunshade has two programmed open opening of the sunroof during Express Close
Manual Open/Close
positions: half open and full open. When opening operation. If an obstruction in the path of the
Push and hold the sunshade switch to open. The sunroof is detected, the sunroof will automatically
the sunshade from the closed position, the
sunshade will open to the half open position and 2
sunshade will always stop at the half open position retract. Remove the obstruction if this occurs.
stop automatically. Push and hold the switch Next, pull the sunroof close switch and release to
regardless of express or manual operation. The
again, and the sunshade will open to the full open Express Close.
switch must be pushed again to continue on to full
position.
open position. NOTE:
Pull and hold the sunshade switch to close. If the If three consecutive sunroof close attempts result
Express Open/Close
sunroof is in closed position, the sunshade will fully in Pinch Protect reversals, Pinch Protect will
Push the sunshade switch to open and release it close from any position. If the sunroof is open or disable and the sunroof must be closed in Manual
within one-half second and the sunshade will open vented, the sunshade will close to the half open Mode.
to the half open position and stop automatically. position and stop. Pulling and holding the switch
Push the switch and release it again, and the again will close both the sunroof and sunshade SUNROOF M AINTENANCE
sunshade will open to the full open position and completely.
stop automatically. Use only a non-abrasive cleaner and a soft cloth to
Any release of the switch will stop the movement clean the glass panel. Periodically check for and
Pull the sunshade switch to close and release it and the sunshade will remain in a partially opened clear out any debris that may have collected in the
within one-half second. If the sunroof is in closed position until the switch is pushed again. tracks.
position, the sunshade will full close automatically
from any position. If the sunroof is open or vented,
the sunshade cannot be closed beyond the half
open position. Pulling the sunshade switch when
the sunshade is in the half open position will
automatically close sunroof prior to the sunshade
closing.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 66
HOOD CAUTION!
OPENING T HE HOOD To prevent possible damage, do not slam the
hood to close it. Lower hood to approximately
Two latches must be released to open the hood. 12 inches (30 cm) and drop the hood to close.
1. Pull the hood release lever located Make sure hood is fully closed for both latches.
underneath the driver’s side of the Never drive vehicle unless hood is fully closed,
instrument panel. with both latches engaged.
The key fob and the overhead console switch will If anything obstructs the power liftgate while it is Lock The Vehicle
open the liftgate when the liftgate is locked. The closing or opening, the liftgate will automatically With a valid Passive Entry key fob within 5 ft
outside handle requires the liftgate to be unlocked. reverse to the closed or open position. After (1.5 m) of the liftgate, pushing the Passive Entry
If the vehicle is equipped with Passive Entry, and a multiple obstructions in the same cycle, the lift- lock button located to the right of the electronic
valid Passive Entry key fob is within 5 ft (1.5 m) of gate will automatically stop and must be opened liftgate release handle will lock the vehicle.
the liftgate, pulling the outside handle will unlock or closed manually.
and open the liftgate. There are pinch sensors attached to the side of WARNING!
NOTE: the liftgate. Light pressure anywhere along
Driving with the liftgate open can allow
Before closing the liftgate, make sure to be in these strips will cause the liftgate to return to
poisonous exhaust gases into your vehicle.
possession of the key because the liftgate may the open position.
You and your passengers could be injured by
be locked. The power liftgate must be in the full open posi- these fumes. Keep the liftgate closed when
Use the interior door lock/unlock button on the tion in order for the rear liftgate close button, on you are operating the vehicle.
door panel or the key fob to lock and unlock the the left rear trim near the liftgate opening, to
If you are required to drive with the liftgate
liftgate. The manual door locks on the doors and operate. If the liftgate is not fully open, push the
liftgate button on the key fob to fully open the open, make sure that all windows are closed,
the exterior door lock cylinder will not lock and and the climate control blower switch is set at
unlock the liftgate. liftgate and then push it again to close.
high speed. Do not use the recirculation
The liftgate will either unlock along with the If the electronic liftgate release handle is mode.
vehicle doors, or it will need to be unlocked by pushed a second time while the power liftgate is
opening, the liftgate motor will disengage to During power operation, personal injury or
pushing the electronic liftgate release,
allow manual operation. cargo damage may occur. Ensure the liftgate
depending on the selected setting in the
travel path is clear. Make sure the liftgate is
Uconnect system Ú page 165. If your liftgate is power closing and you put the
closed and latched before driving away.
The power liftgate buttons will not operate if the vehicle in gear, the liftgate will continue to
vehicle is in gear or the vehicle speed is above power close. However, vehicle movement may Personal injury or cargo damage may occur if
0 mph (0 km/h). result in the detection of an obstruction. caught in the path of the liftgate. Make sure
the liftgate path is clear before activating the
The power liftgate will not operate in tempera- Allow the power system to open the liftgate.
liftgate.
tures below −22°F (−30°C) or temperatures Manually pushing or pulling the liftgate may acti-
above 150°F (65°C). Be sure to remove any vate the liftgate obstacle detection feature and
buildup of snow or ice from the liftgate before stop the power operation or reverse its direc-
pushing any of the power liftgate switches. tion.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 69
73
3
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 74
I NSTRUMENT CLUSTER D ISPLAY The systems allow the driver to select information OK Button
by pushing the following buttons mounted on the
L OCATION AND CONTROLS steering wheel:
Push the OK button to access/select the infor-
mation screens or submenu screens of a main
The instrument cluster display features a driver menu item. Push and hold the OK button for one
interactive display that is located in the instrument second to reset displayed/selected features
cluster. that can be reset.
NOTE: Menu Button — If Equipped
Depending on your vehicle trim, your instrument Push the Menu button to access/select the
cluster display may vary. information screens or submenu screens of
the Home Screen display. Push and hold the
OK button to enter edit mode.
Left Arrow Button
Display Options — If Equipped Custom Tile Configuration — If Equipped The instrument cluster display is located in the
Holding OK will also allow you to change your To customize the instrument cluster further, you center portion of the cluster and consist of multiple
display to Digital or Analog. are able to select up to five tiles to display sections:
Digital theme will be the default theme information based on your needs. Main Screen — The inner ring of the display will
Press the Menu button for the Home Screen display illuminate in gray under normal conditions,
Menu screen times out after 10 seconds. Press yellow for non critical warnings, red for critical
OKto reactivate warnings, and white for on demand information.
Speedometer must always be present Submenu Dots — Whenever there are 3
Relevant warning notifications and other pop-up submenus available, the position within the
info will still be displayed in the main screen submenus is shown here.
area (In this case the speed moves to the top) Reconfigurable Telltales/Information
Gear Selector Status (PRND)
Driver Interactive Display (Compass, Temp,
Range to Empty, Trip A, Trip B, Average Fuel
Economy, Current Fuel Economy and Time)
Menu Button Air Suspension Status — If Equipped
Navigate Left or Right to highlight desired Tile Four Wheel Drive (4WD) Status — If Equipped
Press OK to select the tile and navigate to the
selected submenu and press OK again to add
your selection to your tile view
The main menu options are Main Menu, Vehicle
Info, Navigation, Audio, and Off Road
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 80
The instrument cluster display will normally display Unstored Messages Until RUN Unless reset, this message will continue to
the main menu or the screens of a selected feature These messages deal primarily with the Remote display each time the ignition is cycled to the
of the main menu. The main display area also Start feature. This message type is displayed ON/RUN position.
displays pop-up messages that consist of until the ignition is in the RUN state. Examples of To reset the oil change indicator after performing
approximately 60 possible warning or information this message type are “Remote Start Canceled - the scheduled maintenance, refer to the following
messages. These pop-up messages fall into Door Ajar” and “Press Brake Pedal and Push procedure:
several categories: Button to Start.” 1. Without pressing the brake pedal, push the
Five Second Stored Messages Five Second Unstored Messages ENGINE START/STOP button and cycle the
When the appropriate conditions occur, this When the appropriate conditions occur, this ignition to the ON/RUN position (do not start
type of message takes control of the main type of message takes control of the main the engine).
display area for five seconds and then returns to display area for five seconds and then returns to 2. Fully press the accelerator pedal, slowly, three
the previous screen. Most of the messages of the previous screen. An example of this times within ten seconds.
this type are then stored (as long as the condi- message type is “Automatic High Beams On.”
tion that activated it remains active) and can be 3. Cycle the ignition to the OFF position.
reviewed from the “Messages” main menu item. OIL C HANGE R ESET
NOTE:
Examples of this message type are “Right Front
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil If the indicator message illuminates when you start
Turn Signal Lamp Out” and “Low Tire Pressure.”
change indicator system. The “Oil Change Due” the vehicle, the oil change indicator system did not
Unstored Messages message will display in the instrument cluster reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
This message type is displayed indefinitely or display for five seconds after a single chime has
until the condition that activated the message is sounded, to indicate the next scheduled oil
cleared. Examples of this message type are change interval. The engine oil change indicator
“Turn Signal On” (if a turn signal is left on) and system is duty cycle based, which means the
“Lights On” (if driver leaves the vehicle with the engine oil change interval may fluctuate, depen-
lights on). dent upon your personal driving style.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 81
The Reconfigurable Telltales section is divided into the white or yellow telltales area on the left, and the green or red telltales area on the right.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 82
VEHICLE INFO (CUSTOMER INFORMATION 3. Transmission Temperature — Automatic Push the Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) ON/OFF
FEATURES) Transmission Only button (located on the steering wheel) until one of
Displays the actual transmission tempera- the following displays in the instrument cluster
Push and release the up or down arrow display:
button until the Vehicle Info Menu item is displayed ture.
Adaptive Cruise Control Off
in the instrument cluster display. Push and release 4. Oil Temperature
the left or right arrow button to cycle through When ACC is deactivated, the display will read
Displays the level of oil temperature. “Adaptive Cruise Control Off.”
the Vehicle Info submenus and follow the prompts
on each screen as needed. 5. Battery Voltage Adaptive Cruise Control Ready 3
1. Tire Pressure Displays the actual battery voltage. When ACC is activated but the vehicle speed
If tire pressure is OK for all tires a vehicle
setting has not been selected, the display will read
ICON is displayed with tire pressure values 6. Clutch Message — If Equipped “Adaptive Cruise Control Ready.”
in each corner of the ICON. “Drive in First Gear” message will be shown Push and release the SET + or the SET- button
If one or more tires have low pressure, in manual transmission vehicle during initial (located on the steering wheel) and the following
“Inflate Tire To XX” is displayed with the launch and any time the vehicle speed fluc- will display in the instrument cluster display:
vehicle ICON and the tire pressure values in tuates below 5mph (8 km/h). ACC SET
each corner of the ICON with the pressure When ACC is set, the set speed will display in the
value of the low tire displayed in a different DRIVER ASSIST instrument cluster.
color than the other tire pressure value.
Push and release the up or down arrow The ACC screen may display once again if any ACC
If the Tire Pressure system requires service, button until the Driver Assist menu title is activity occurs, which may include any of the
“Service Tire Pressure System” is displayed. highlighted in the instrument cluster display. following:
Tire PSI is an information only function and The instrument cluster display displays the current Distance Setting Change
cannot be reset Ú page 201. ACC system settings. The information displayed System Cancel
2. Coolant Temperature depends on ACC system status.
Driver Override
Displays the actual coolant temperature.
System Off
ACC Proximity Warning
ACC Unavailable Warning
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 84
Active Lane Management Warning (If Greeting Lights: activate the direction indicators Door Unlock: allow you to choose whether to
Equipped): a selection of the “readiness” of when unlocking the doors unlock all the doors or only the driver’s side door
intervention of Active Lane Management Daytime Lights (If Equipped): activate/deacti- on the first push of the unlock button on the key
Buzzer Volume: There are 4 options: Off, Low, vate the daytime running lights Auto Driver Comfort (If Equipped): activate/
Medium, Loud Cornering Lights (If Equipped): activate/deacti- deactivate automatic climate control during
Brake Service (If Equipped): activation of the vate the cornering lights vehicle starts
procedure to carry out braking system mainte- Auto High Beam (If Equipped): activate/deacti- Key in Memory (If Equipped): activate/deacti-
nance vate the automatic high beam headlights vate memory linked to a key 3
Auto Park Brake (If Equipped): enable/disable Doors And Locks Compass
auto insertion of the Electric Park Brake By selecting Compass, the following settings can
By selecting Doors and Locks, the following
Hill Start Assist: Activation/Deactivation of the adjustments can be made: be changed:
Hill Start Assist system Calibration (If Equipped)
Auto Unlock Doors: automatic unlocking of the
Lights — If Equipped doors when exiting the vehicle This compass is self-calibrating, which eliminates
By selecting Lights, the following adjustments can Lights with Lock: activate the direction indica- the need to set the compass manually. When the
be made: tors when locking the doors vehicle is new, the compass may appear erratic,
Ambient Lights (If Equipped): adjust the sensi- and the cluster will display dashes (- -) until the
Horn With Remote Lock: activate/deactivate the compass is calibrated. You may also calibrate the
tivity of lighting in the doors and overhead horn when pressing the lock button on the key.
console compass by completing one or more 360 degree
The options are “Off”, “First Press”, and turns (in an area free from large metal or metallic
Lights Off Delay: set the delay for headlight “Second Press” objects) until the dashes (- -) displayed in the
shutoff after engine shutoff Horn With Remote Start (If Equipped): activate/ instrument cluster display turns off. The compass
Headlight Sensitivity: adjust the sensitivity of deactivate the horn at the Remote Starting of will now function normally.
headlight brightness the engine with the key
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 88
Variance (If Equipped) BATTERY SAVER O N/BATTERY S AVER These messages indicate the vehicle battery has a
low state of charge and continues to lose electrical
Compass Variance is the difference between MODE MESSAGE — ELECTRICAL L OAD charge at a rate that the charging system cannot
Magnetic North and Geographic North. To
compensate for the differences, the variance REDUCTION ACTIONS — I F EQUIPPED sustain.
should be set for the zone where the vehicle is This vehicle is equipped with an Intelligent Battery NOTE:
driven, per the zone map. Once properly set, the Sensor (IBS) to perform additional monitoring of The charging system is independent from load
compass will automatically compensate for the the electrical system and status of the vehicle reduction. The charging system performs a diag-
differences and provide the most accurate battery. nostic on the charging system continuously.
compass heading.
In cases when the IBS detects charging system If the Battery Charge Warning Light is on it may
failure, or the vehicle battery conditions are indicate a problem with the charging system
deteriorating, electrical load reduction actions will Ú page 90.
take place to extend the driving time and distance The electrical loads that may be switched off
of the vehicle. This is done by reducing power to or (if equipped), and vehicle functions which can be
turning off non-essential electrical loads. effected by load reduction:
Load reduction is only active when the engine is Heated Seat/Vented Seats/Heated Wheel
running. It will display a message if there is a risk
of battery depletion to the point where the vehicle Heated/Cooled Cup Holders — If Equipped
may stall due to lack of electrical supply, or will not Rear Defroster And Heated Mirrors
restart after the current drive cycle. HVAC System
Compass Variance Map When load reduction is activated, the message 150W Power Inverter System
“Battery Saver On” or “Battery Saver Mode” will
appear in the instrument cluster display. Audio and Telematics System
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 89
Brake Warning Light NOTE: The light also will turn on when the parking brake
The light may flash momentarily during sharp is applied with the ignition switch in the ON/RUN
This warning light monitors various brake
cornering maneuvers, which change fluid level position.
functions, including brake fluid level and
parking brake application. If the brake conditions. The vehicle should have service NOTE:
light turns on it may indicate that the performed, and the brake fluid level checked. This light shows only that the parking brake is
parking brake is applied, that the brake fluid level If brake failure is indicated, immediate repair is applied. It does not show the degree of brake appli-
is low, or that there is a problem with the Anti-Lock necessary. cation.
Brake System reservoir. Battery Charge Warning Light
WARNING!
If the light remains on when the parking brake has This warning light will illuminate when the
been disengaged, and the fluid level is at the full Driving a vehicle with the red brake light on is battery is not charging properly. If it stays
mark on the master cylinder reservoir, it indicates dangerous. Part of the brake system may have on while the engine is running, there may
a possible brake hydraulic system malfunction or failed. It will take longer to stop the vehicle. You be a malfunction with the charging
that a problem with the Brake Booster has been could have a collision. Have the vehicle checked system. Contact an authorized dealer as soon
detected by the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) / immediately. as possible.
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system. In this
case, the light will remain on until the condition has This indicates a possible problem with the
Vehicles equipped with the Anti-Lock Brake System electrical system or a related component.
been corrected. If the problem is related to the (ABS) are also equipped with Electronic Brake
brake booster, the ABS pump will run when Force Distribution (EBD). In the event of an EBD Door Open Warning Light
applying the brake, and a brake pedal pulsation failure, the Brake Warning Light will turn on along This indicator will illuminate when a door
may be felt during each stop. with the ABS Light. Immediate repair to the ABS is ajar/open and not fully closed.
The dual brake system provides a reserve braking system is required.
capacity in the event of a failure to a portion of the Operation of the Brake Warning Light can be NOTE:
hydraulic system. A leak in either half of the dual checked by turning the ignition switch from the OFF If the vehicle is moving, there will also be a single
brake system is indicated by the Brake Warning position to the ON/RUN position. The light should chime.
Light, which will turn on when the brake fluid level illuminate for approximately two seconds. The light
in the master cylinder has dropped below a should then turn off unless the parking brake is
specified level. applied or a brake fault is detected. If the light does
The light will remain on until the cause is corrected. not illuminate, have the light inspected by an
authorized dealer.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 91
Drowsiness Detected Warning — flash depending on the nature of the problem. temperature reading does not return to normal,
If Equipped Cycle the ignition when the vehicle is safely and turn the engine off immediately and call for service
completely stopped and the transmission is placed Ú page 261.
Driver drowsiness detection helps to in the PARK position. The light should turn off. If
avoid crashes caused by fatigue by Hood Open Warning Light
the light remains on with the vehicle running, your
advising drivers to take a break in time. vehicle will usually be drivable; however, see an This warning light will illuminate when the
Once Drowsy Driver is detected, A pop-up authorized dealer for service as soon as possible. hood is left open and not fully closed.
will display continuously until the driver presses
NOTE:
the OK button to clear.
NOTE: 3
This light may turn on if the accelerator and brake
Once the pop-up message is cleared, it is stored If the vehicle is moving, there will also be a single
pedals are pressed at the same time.
until the condition is no longer true. chime.
If the light continues to flash when the vehicle is
Electric Power Steering (EPS) Fault running, immediate service is required and you Liftgate Open Warning Light
Warning Light may experience reduced performance, an This warning light will illuminate when the
This warning light will turn on when elevated/rough idle, or engine stall and your liftgate is open.
there's a fault with the EPS system vehicle may require towing. The light will come on
Ú page 114. when the ignition is placed in the ON/RUN position
and remain on briefly as a bulb check. If the light NOTE:
does not come on during starting, have the system If the vehicle is moving, there will also be a single
WARNING! checked by an authorized dealer. chime.
Engine Temperature Warning Light Oil Pressure Warning Light
Continued operation with reduced assist could
pose a safety risk to yourself and others. Service This warning light will illuminate to warn This warning light will illuminate to
should be obtained as soon as possible. of an overheated engine condition. If the indicate low engine oil pressure. If the
engine coolant temperature is too high, light turns on while driving, stop the
this light will illuminate and a single vehicle, shut off the engine as soon as
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) Warning chime will sound. possible, and contact an authorized dealer.
Light A chime will sound when this light turns on.
If the light turns on while driving, safely pull over
This warning light will illuminate to and stop the vehicle. If the Air Conditioning (A/C) Do not operate the vehicle until the cause is
indicate a problem with the ETC system. system is on, turn it off. Also, shift the transmission corrected. This light does not indicate how much oil
If a problem is detected while the vehicle into NEUTRAL (N) and idle the vehicle. If the is in the engine. The engine oil level must be
is running, the light will either stay on or checked under the hood.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 92
Oil Temperature Warning Light Transmission Temperature Warning Light — Vehicle Security Warning Light —
This warning light will illuminate to If Equipped If Equipped
indicate the engine oil temperature is This warning light will illuminate to warn This light will flash at a fast rate for
high. If the light turns on while driving, of a high transmission fluid temperature. approximately 15 seconds when the
stop the vehicle and shut off the engine This may occur with strenuous usage Vehicle Security system is arming,
as soon as possible. Wait for oil temperature to such as trailer towing. If this light turns and then will flash slowly until the vehicle
return to normal levels. on, stop the vehicle and run the engine at idle or is disarmed.
Seat Belt Reminder Warning Light slightly faster, with the transmission in PARK or
NEUTRAL, until the light turns off. Once the light YELLOW WARNING LIGHTS
This warning light indicates when the
turns off, you may continue to drive normally. Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Warning
driver or passenger seat belt is
unbuckled. When the ignition is first WARNING! Light
placed in the ON/RUN position and if the This warning light monitors the ABS.
driver’s seat belt is unbuckled, a chime will sound If you continue operating the vehicle when the The light will turn on when the ignition is
and the light will turn on. When driving, if the driver Transmission Temperature Warning Light is placed in the ON/RUN position and may
or front passenger seat belt remains unbuckled, illuminated you could cause the fluid to boil over, stay on for as long as four seconds.
the Seat Belt Reminder Light will flash or remain on come in contact with hot engine or exhaust
continuously and a chime will sound Ú page 204. components and cause a fire. If the ABS light remains on or turns on while
driving, then the Anti-Lock portion of the brake
Transmission Fault Warning Light system is not functioning and service is required as
This light will illuminate (together with a CAUTION! soon as possible. However, the conventional brake
message in the instrument cluster system will continue to operate normally,
display and a buzzer) to indicate a Continuous driving with the Transmission assuming the Brake Warning Light is not also on.
transmission fault. Contact an authorized Temperature Warning Light illuminated will
If the ABS light does not turn on when the ignition
dealer if the message remains after restarting eventually cause severe transmission damage
is placed in the ON/RUN position, have the brake
the engine. or transmission failure.
system inspected by an authorized dealer.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 93
Electronic Park Brake Warning Light Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF Low Coolant Level Warning Light
This warning light will illuminate to Warning Light — If Equipped This telltale will turn on to indicate the
indicate the Electronic Park Brake is not This warning light indicates the vehicle coolant level is low Ú page 279.
functioning properly and service is ESC is off.
required. Contact an authorized dealer.
Low Fuel Warning Light
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Active Each time the ignition is turned to ON/RUN, the Depending on whether the tank size is
Warning Light — If Equipped ESC system will be on, even if it was turned off 13.5 gal (51 L) or 15.8 gal (60 L), the
previously. Low Fuel Indicator Light will turn on when
3
This warning light will indicate when the
ESC system is Active. The ESC Indicator Fuel Cutoff Warning Light — If Equipped the fuel level goes below 1.5 gal (5.6 L) or
Light in the instrument cluster will come 1.7 gal (6.6 L) respectively.
This warning light will illuminate after an
on when the ignition is placed in the ON/ Low Washer Fluid Warning Light —
accident has occurred, and the system
RUN position, and when ESC is activated. It should
go out with the engine running. If the ESC Indicator
has shut the fuel off. If Equipped
Light comes on continuously with the engine Active Lane Management Warning Light — This warning light will illuminate when the
running, a malfunction has been detected in the If Equipped windshield washer fluid is low.
ESC system. If this warning light remains on after
The Active Lane Management Warning
several ignition cycles, and the vehicle has been
Light will be solid yellow when the vehicle Engine Check/Malfunction Indicator (MIL)
driven several miles (kilometers) at speeds greater
is approaching a lane marker. The Warning Light
than 30 mph (48 km/h), see an authorized dealer
warning light will flash when the vehicle is
as soon as possible to have the problem The MIL is a part of an Onboard
crossing the lane marker.
diagnosed and corrected. Diagnostic System called OBD II that
The ESC OFF Indicator Light and the ESC Indi-
Service Active Lane Management Warning monitors engine and automatic
cator Light come on momentarily each time the Light — If Equipped transmission control systems. This
ignition is placed in the ON/RUN position. This warning light will illuminate when the warning light will illuminate when the ignition is in
Active Lane Management system is not the ON/RUN position before engine start. If the
The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking bulb does not come on when turning the ignition
sounds when it is active. This is normal; the operating and requires service. Please
see an authorized dealer. switch from OFF to ON/RUN, have the condition
sounds will stop when ESC becomes inactive. checked promptly.
This light will come on when the vehicle is in an
ESC event.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 94
Certain conditions, such as a loose or missing gas Service Stop/Start System Warning Light —
cap, poor quality fuel, etc., may illuminate the light CAUTION!
If Equipped
after engine start. The vehicle should be serviced if Prolonged driving with the Malfunction Indicator
the light stays on through several typical driving This warning light will illuminate when the
Light (MIL) on could cause damage to the
styles. In most situations, the vehicle will drive Stop/Start system is not functioning
vehicle control system. It also could affect fuel
normally and will not require towing. properly and service is required. Contact
economy and driveability. If the MIL is flashing,
an authorized dealer for service.
When the engine is running, the MIL may flash to severe catalytic converter damage and power
alert serious conditions that could lead to loss will soon occur. Immediate service is Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
immediate loss of power or severe catalytic required. Warning Light — If Equipped
converter damage. The vehicle should be serviced The warning light switches on and a
by an authorized dealer as soon as possible if this Service 4WD Warning Light — If Equipped message is displayed to indicate that the
occurs. tire pressure is lower than the
This warning light will illuminate to signal
a fault with the 4WD system. If the light recommended value and/or that slow
WARNING! pressure loss is occurring. In these cases, optimal
stays on or comes on during driving, it
A malfunctioning catalytic converter, as means that the 4WD system is not tire duration and fuel consumption may not be
referenced above, can reach higher functioning properly and that service is required. guaranteed.
temperatures than in normal operating We recommend you drive to the nearest service Should one or more tires be in the condition
conditions. This can cause a fire if you drive center and have the vehicle serviced immediately. mentioned above, the display will show the
slowly or park over flammable substances such indications corresponding to each tire.
as dry plants, wood, cardboard, etc. This could Service Forward Collision Warning (FCW)
result in death or serious injury to the driver, Light — If Equipped CAUTION!
occupants or others. This warning light will illuminate to Do not continue driving with one or more flat
indicate a fault in the Forward Collision tires as handling may be compromised. Stop the
Warning System. Contact an authorized vehicle, avoiding sharp braking and steering. If a
dealer for service Ú page 198. tire puncture occurs, repair immediately using
the dedicated tire repair kit and contact an
authorized dealer as soon as possible.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 95
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS
be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the malfunction indicator to indicate when the system CAUTION!
inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction The TPMS has been optimized for the original
manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire indicator is combined with the low tire pressure equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures
inflation pressure label. If your vehicle has tires of telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, and warning have been established for the tire
a different size than the size indicated on the the telltale will flash for approximately one minute size equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you and then remain continuously illuminated. This system operation or sensor damage may result
should determine the proper tire inflation pressure sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle when using replacement equipment that is not
for those tires. start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When of the same size, type, and/or style. Aftermarket 3
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the wheels can cause sensor damage. Using
equipped with a TPMS that illuminates a low tire system may not be able to detect or signal low tire aftermarket tire sealants may cause the Tire
pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) sensor to
significantly underinflated. Accordingly, when the occur for a variety of reasons, including the become inoperable. After using an aftermarket
low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should installation of replacement or alternate tires or tire sealant it is recommended that you take
stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from your vehicle to an authorized dealer to have your
inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a functioning properly. Always check the TPMS sensor function checked.
significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to malfunction telltale after replacing one or more
overheat and can lead to tire failure. Underinflation tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the
replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow Towing Hook Breakdown Warning Light —
also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and
may affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping the TPMS to continue to function properly. If Equipped
ability. This light illuminates when there is a
failure with the tow hook. Contact an
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for
authorized dealer for service.
proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s
responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure,
even if underinflation has not reached the level to
trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure
telltale.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 96
YELLOW INDICATOR LIGHTS Active Speed Limiter Fault Indicator Light — GREEN INDICATOR L IGHTS
If Equipped
4WD Low Indicator Light — If Equipped Auto HOLD Indicator Light — If Equipped
This warning light will illuminate to signal
This light alerts the driver that the vehicle when there is a fault detected with the Auto HOLD keeps your vehicle at a
is in the 4WD Low mode. The front and Active Speed Limiter. complete stop without you having to keep
rear driveshafts are mechanically locked your foot on the brake pedal. Once
together forcing the front and rear Forward Collision Warning (FCW) Indicator engaged a green HOLD indicator will
wheels to rotate at the same speed. Low range Light — If Equipped appear in the Instrument Cluster Display.
provides a greater gear reduction ratio to provide This telltale will turn on to warn you of a Active Lane Management Indicator Light —
increased torque at the wheels Ú page 112. possible collision with the vehicle in front If Equipped
4WD Lock Indicator Light of you.
The Active Lane Management indicator
This light alerts the driver that the vehicle Forward Collision Warning (FCW) OFF light illuminates solid green when both
is in the 4WD Lock mode. The front and Indicator Light — If Equipped lane markings have been detected and
rear driveshafts are mechanically locked the system is “armed” and ready to
together, forcing the front and rear This indicator light illuminates to indicate
that Forward Collision Warning is off. provide visual and torque warnings if an
wheels to rotate at the same speed Ú page 112. unintentional lane departure occurs.
Auto HOLD! Fault Indicator Light — Parking/Headlights On Indicator Light
If Equipped Immobilizer Fail / VPS Electrical Alarm
This indicator light will illuminate when
Indicator Light
The Auto HOLD! Fault Indicator light will the parking lights or headlights are
illuminate if a fault is detected, it will be This telltale will illuminate when the turned on.
indicated by a yellow HOLD! indicator Vehicle Security system has detected an
attempt to break into the vehicle. Front Fog Indicator Light — If Equipped
light that will stay on as long as the fault
condition exists. NOTE: This indicator light will illuminate when
After cycling the ignition to the ON/RUN position, the front fog lights are on Ú page 43.
the Vehicle Security Warning Light could illuminate
if a problem with the system is detected. This
condition will result in the engine being shut off
after two seconds.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 97
Turn Signal Indicator Lights Automatic High Beam Indicator Light — Cruise Control Ready Indicator Light —
When the left or right turn signal is If Equipped If Equipped With A Premium Instrument
activated, the turn signal indicator will This indicator shows that the automatic Cluster
flash independently and the high beam headlights are on Ú page 43. This light will turn on when the Cruise
corresponding exterior turn signal lamps
Control has been turned on, but not set
will flash. Turn signals can be activated when
Ú page 117.
the multifunction lever is moved down (left) or WHITE INDICATOR L IGHTS
up (right). Cruise Control SET Indicator Light —
Active Lane Management Indicator Light — 3
NOTE: If Equipped
If Equipped
A continuous chime will sound if the vehicle is This indicator light will illuminate when
When the Active Lane Management the Cruise Control is set Ú page 117.
driven more than 1 mile (1.6 km) with either
system is ON, but not armed, the Active
turn signal on.
Lane Management indicator light
Check for an inoperative outside light bulb if illuminates solid white. This occurs when BLUE INDICATOR L IGHTS
either indicator flashes at a rapid rate. only left, right, or neither lane line has been
detected. If a single lane line is detected, the High Beam Indicator Light
Cruise Control SET Indicator Light —
system is ready to provide only visual warnings if This indicator light will illuminate to
If Equipped With A Premium Instrument
an unintentional lane departure occurs on the indicate that the high beam headlights
Cluster detected lane line Ú page 145. are on. With the low beams activated,
This indicator light will illuminate when push the multifunction lever forward
Hill Descent Control (HDC) Indicator
the Cruise Control is set to the desired (toward the front of the vehicle) to turn on the high
speed Ú page 117. Light — If Equipped beams. Pull the multifunction lever rearward
This indicator shows when the HDC (toward the rear of the vehicle) to turn off the high
Stop/Start Active Indicator Light —
feature is turned on. The lamp will be on beams. If the high beams are off, pull the lever
If Equipped solid when HDC is armed. HDC can only toward you for a temporary high beam on, “flash to
This indicator light will illuminate when be armed when the transfer case is in the pass” scenario.
the Stop/Start function is in “Autostop” 4WD Low position and the vehicle speed is less
mode. then 30 mph (48 km/h). If these conditions are not
met while attempting to use the HDC feature, the
HDC indicator light will flash on/off.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 98
100
3. The system starts the vehicle. If the vehicle EXTENDED P ARK S TARTING AFTER S TARTING — WARMING UP THE
fails to start, the starter will disengage
automatically after 10 seconds. NOTE: ENGINE
Extended Park condition occurs when the vehicle The idle speed is controlled automatically and it
4. If you wish to stop the cranking of the engine
has not been started or driven for at least 30 days. will decrease as the engine warms up.
prior to the engine starting, push the ENGINE
START/STOP button again. 1. Install a battery charger or jumper cables to
the battery to ensure a full battery charge I F E NGINE F AILS T O S TART
Keyless Enter ’n Go™ — With Driver’s Foot OFF The during the crank cycle. If the engine fails to start after you have followed
Brake Pedal (In PARK Or NEUTRAL Position) 2. Place the ignition in the START position and the “Normal Starting” procedure, and has not
The Keyless Enter ’n Go™ feature operates similar release it when the engine starts. experienced an Extended Park condition as
to an ignition switch. It has three positions, OFF, 3. If the engine fails to start within 10 seconds, identified in “Extended Park Starting” procedure, it 4
ON/RUN, and START. To change the ignition switch place the ignition in the OFF position, wait may be flooded. Push the accelerator pedal all the
positions without starting the vehicle and use the 10 to 15 seconds to allow the starter to cool, way to the floor and hold it there. Crank the engine
accessories follow, these steps starting with the then repeat the “Extended Park Starting” for no more than 15 seconds. This should clear any
ignition switch in the OFF position: procedure. excess fuel in case the engine is flooded. Leave the
1. Push the ENGINE START/STOP button once to ignition key in the ON/RUN position, release the
4. If the engine fails to start after eight attempts, accelerator pedal and repeat the “Normal
change the ignition switch to the ON/RUN allow the starter to cool for at least
position. Starting” procedure.
10 minutes, then repeat the procedure.
2. Push the ENGINE START/STOP button a CAUTION!
second time to change the ignition switch to CAUTION!
the OFF position. To prevent damage to the starter, do not
To prevent damage to the starter, do not crank continuously crank the engine for more than
COLD WEATHER OPERATION continuously for more than 10 seconds at a 25 seconds at a time. Wait 60 seconds before
time. Wait 10 to 15 seconds before trying again. trying again.
(B ELOW –22°F OR −30°C)
To ensure reliable starting at these temperatures,
use of an externally powered electric engine block
heater (available from an authorized dealer) is
recommended.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 102
Turning off the car (placing the ignition from the NOTE:
WARNING! ON/RUN position to the OFF position), the power The engine block heater cord is a factory
Never pour fuel or other flammable liquid into supply to the accessories are maintained for a installed option. If your vehicle is not equipped,
the throttle body air inlet opening in an period of three minutes. heater cords are available from an authorized
attempt to start the vehicle. This could result Opening the driver’s side door with the ignition in dealer.
in flash fire causing serious personal injury. ON/RUN will sound a short chime that reminds the The engine block heater will require 110 Volt AC
Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to driver to place the ignition to OFF. and 6.5 Amps to activate the heater element.
get it started. Vehicles equipped with an auto- When the ignition is in the OFF position, the The engine block heater must be plugged in at
matic transmission cannot be started this window switches remain active for three minutes. least one hour to have an adequate warming
way. Unburned fuel could enter the catalytic Opening a front door will cancel this function. effect on the engine.
converter and once the engine has started, After severe driving, idle the engine to allow the
ignite and damage the converter and vehicle. temperature inside the engine compartment to WARNING!
If the vehicle has a discharged battery, cool before shutting off the engine. Remember to disconnect the engine block
booster cables may be used to obtain a start heater cord before driving. Damage to the
from a booster battery or the battery in ENGINE BLOCK HEATER — IF EQUIPPED 110-115 Volt electrical cord could cause
another vehicle. This type of start can be electrocution.
The engine block heater warms the engine and
dangerous if done improperly Ú page 258.
permits quicker starts in cold weather.
While cruising, brief full-throttle acceleration within The parking brake is primarily intended to prevent and an indicator on the switch will illuminate. If
the limits of local traffic laws contributes to a good the vehicle from rolling while parked. Before your foot is on the brake pedal while you apply the
break-in. Wide-open throttle acceleration in low leaving the vehicle, make sure that the parking parking brake, you may notice a small amount of
gear can be detrimental and should be avoided. brake is applied. Also, be certain to leave the brake pedal movement. The parking brake can be
The engine oil installed in the engine at the factory transmission in PARK. applied even when the ignition switch is OFF. The
is a high-quality energy conserving type lubricant. You can engage the parking brake in two ways: Brake Warning Light will not illuminate and can
Oil changes should be consistent with anticipated only be released when the ignition switch is in the
Manually, by applying the EPB switch. ON/RUN position.
climate conditions under which vehicle operations
Automatically, by enabling the Auto Park Brake
will occur. For the recommended viscosity and NOTE:
quality grades Ú page 323. feature in the Customer Programmable
The EPB fault lamp will illuminate if the EPB switch
Features section of the Uconnect settings
is held for longer than 60 seconds in either the 4
CAUTION! Ú page 165.
released or applied position. The light will extin-
The EPB switch is located in the center console. guish upon releasing the switch.
Never use Non-Detergent Oil or Straight Mineral
Oil in the engine or damage may result. If the Auto Park Brake feature is enabled, the
parking brake will automatically engage whenever
the transmission is placed into PARK. If your foot is
NOTE: on the brake pedal, you may notice a small amount
A new engine may consume some oil during its first of brake pedal movement while the parking brake
few thousand miles (kilometers) of operation. This is engaging.
should be considered a normal part of the break-in
and not interpreted as a problem. The parking brake will release automatically when
the ignition switch is ON/RUN, the transmission is
PARK BRAKE in DRIVE or REVERSE, the driver’s seat belt is
buckled, and an attempt is made to drive away.
ELECTRIC P ARK B RAKE (EPB) Electric Park Brake Switch To release the parking brake manually, the ignition
switch must be in the ON/RUN position. Put your
Your vehicle is equipped with an EPB system that To apply the parking brake manually, pull up on the foot on the brake pedal, then push the EPB switch
offers simple operation, and some additional switch momentarily. You may hear a sound from down momentarily. You may hear a sound from the
features that make the parking brake more the back of the vehicle while the parking brake back of the car while the parking brake
convenient and useful. engages. Once the parking brake is fully engaged, disengages. You may also notice a small amount of
the BRAKE warning lamp in the instrument cluster movement in the brake pedal. Once the parking
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 104
In the unlikely event of a malfunction of the EPB For automatic transmissions, the EPB will Auto Hold can be activated or deactivated by
system, a yellow EPB fault lamp will illuminate. This automatically engage if all of the following pushing the HOLD button located on the switch
may be accompanied by the Brake Warning Light conditions are met: bank.
flashing. In this event, urgent service of the EPB Vehicle speed is below 1.9 mph (3 km/h).
system is required. Do not rely on the parking
brake to hold the vehicle stationary. There is no attempt to press the brake pedal
and accelerator pedal.
Auto Park Brake
The seat belt is unbuckled.
The EPB can be programmed to be applied
The driver’s door is open.
automatically whenever the vehicle speed is below
1.9 mph (3 km/h) and the transmission is placed The vehicle is not in the PARK position.
in PARK. Auto Park Brake is enabled and disabled SafeHold can be temporarily bypassed by pushing
4
by customer selection through the Customer the EPB switch while the driver’s door is open and
Programmable Features section of the Uconnect the brake pedal is pressed. Once manually
Settings Ú page 165. bypassed, SafeHold will be enabled again once the Auto Hold Switch
Any single Auto Park Brake application can be vehicle reaches 12 mph (20 km/h) or the ignition
bypassed by pushing the EPB switch to the release is turned to the OFF position and back to ON/RUN The following conditions must be met for Auto Hold
position while the transmission is placed in PARK again. to activate:
and the ignition is in the ON/RUN position. Auto Hold — If Equipped Driver’s door is closed
SafeHold Auto Hold is a comfort feature that allows the Driver's seat belt is fastened
SafeHold is a safety feature of the EPB system that driver to remove their foot from the brake pedal Vehicle is at a standstill
will engage the parking brake automatically if the once the vehicle has come to a stop. The vehicle Forward gear is selected
vehicle is left unsecured while the ignition switch is must be held at a standstill for a predetermined
amount of time by hydraulic braking. The EPB will Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) is not engaged
in ON/RUN.
then engage and continue to hold the vehicle at a EPB is not applied
stop until the driver applies the accelerator pedal. ParkSense Active Park Assist System auto
parking maneuver is not activated
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 106
Brake Service Mode While in Service Mode, the EPB fault lamp will flash
continuously while the ignition switch is ON/RUN.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
We recommend having your brakes serviced by an
You must press and hold the brake pedal while
authorized dealer. NOTE:
shifting out of PARK.
You should only make repairs for which you have A dedicated message will appear in the instrument
the knowledge and the right equipment. You cluster display if Brake Service Mode cannot be
WARNING!
should only enter Brake Service Mode during activated.
When brake service work is complete, the following Never use the PARK (P) position as a substi-
brake service.
steps must be followed to reset the parking brake tute for the parking brake. Always apply the
When servicing your rear brakes, it may be parking brake fully when exiting the vehicle to
system to normal operation:
necessary for you or your technician to push the guard against vehicle movement and possible
rear piston into the rear caliper bore. With the EPB Ensure the vehicle is at a standstill.
injury or damage.
system, this can only be done after retracting the Press the brake pedal with moderate force.
EPB actuator. The actuator retraction can be done Your vehicle could move and injure you and
Apply the EPB Switch. others if it is not in PARK. Check by trying to
easily by entering the Brake Service Mode through
the Uconnect Settings in your vehicle. This NOTE: move the gear selector out of PARK with the
menu-based system will guide you through the A dedicated message will appear in the instrument brake pedal released. Make sure the trans-
steps necessary to retract the EPB actuator in cluster display if Brake Service Mode cannot be mission is in PARK before exiting the vehicle.
order to perform rear brake service. deactivated. It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or
Service Mode has requirements that must be met NEUTRAL (N) if the engine speed is higher
WARNING!
in order to be activated: than idle speed. If your foot is not firmly
You can be badly injured working on or around a pressing the brake pedal, the vehicle could
The vehicle must be at a standstill.
motor vehicle. Do only that service work for accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You
The parking brake must be disabled. which you have the knowledge and the right could lose control of the vehicle and hit
The transmission must be in PARK or NEUTRAL. equipment. If you have any doubt about your someone or something. Only shift into gear
ability to perform a service job, take your vehicle when the engine is idling normally and your
The EPB switch not activated.
to a competent mechanic. foot is firmly pressing the brake pedal.
The vehicle in ignition ON/RUN position.
The vehicle may not engage a newly selected
The brake pedal not pressed.
gear when shifting between PARK, REVERSE
(R), or DRIVE (D) if the vehicle is moving while
shifting.
(Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 107
The following indicators should be used to ensure When frequent transmission shifting occurs (such
that you have properly engaged the transmission WARNING! as when operating the vehicle under heavy loading
into the PARK position: Do not coast in NEUTRAL and never turn off the conditions, in hilly terrain, traveling into strong
When shifting into PARK, push the lock button ignition to coast down a hill. These are unsafe head winds, or while towing a heavy trailer), use
on the gear selector, and firmly move the practices that limit your response to changing the AutoStick shift control to select a lower gear
selector all the way forward until it stops and is traffic or road conditions. You might lose control Ú page 111. Under these conditions, using a lower
fully seated. of the vehicle and have a collision. gear will improve performance and extend
transmission life by reducing excessive shifting
Look at the transmission gear position display and heat build-up.
and verify that it indicates the PARK position (P).
CAUTION! If the transmission temperature exceeds normal
With the brake pedal released, verify that the operating limits, the transmission controller may
gear selector will not move out of PARK. Towing the vehicle, coasting, or driving for any
other reason with the transmission in NEUTRAL modify the transmission shift schedule, reduce
REVERSE (R) can cause severe transmission damage. engine torque, and/or expand the range of torque
converter clutch engagement. This is done to
This range is for moving the vehicle backward. For Recreational Towing Ú page 160. prevent transmission damage due to overheating.
Shift into REVERSE only after the vehicle has come
For Towing A Disabled Vehicle Ú page 264. If the transmission becomes extremely hot, the
to a complete stop.
Transmission Temperature Warning Light may
NEUTRAL (N) DRIVE (D) illuminate, and the transmission may operate
differently until the transmission cools down.
Use this range when the vehicle is standing for This range should be used for most city and
prolonged periods with the engine running. The During cold temperatures, transmission operation
highway driving. It provides the smoothest upshifts
engine may be started in this range. Apply the may be modified depending on engine and/or
and downshifts, and the best fuel economy. The
parking brake and shift the transmission into transmission temperature as well as vehicle
transmission automatically upshifts through all
PARK if you must exit the vehicle. speed. This feature improves warm-up time of the
forward gears.
engine and transmission to achieve maximum
efficiency. Engagement of the torque converter
clutch (and, for the 9-speed, shifts into EIGHTH or
NINTH gear), are inhibited until the engine and/or
transmission is warm. Normal operation will
resume once the temperature(s) have risen to a
suitable level.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 111
5. Restart the engine. the transmission is not shifting properly when the Four-Wheel Drive (4x4)
6. Shift into the desired gear range. If the vehicle is cold. This is normal. The torque converter
The four-wheel drive (4WD) is fully automatic in
problem is no longer detected, the clutch will function normally once the powertrain is
normal driving mode.
transmission will return to normal operation. sufficiently warm.
NOTE:
NOTE: FOUR-WHEEL DRIVE OPERATION — It is not possible to carry out the change of mode
when the vehicle exceeds the speed of 75 mph
Even if the transmission can be reset, we
recommend that you visit an authorized dealer at IF EQUIPPED (120 km/h).
your earliest possible convenience. An authorized
dealer has diagnostic equipment to assess the
J EEP® ACTIVE DRIVE
condition of your transmission. If the transmission Your vehicle may be equipped with a Power
cannot be reset, authorized dealer service is Transfer Unit (PTU). This system is automatic
required. with no driver inputs or additional driving skills
required. Under normal driving conditions, the
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH front wheels provide most of the traction. If the
A feature designed to improve fuel economy has front wheels begin to lose traction, power is shifted
been included in the automatic transmission on automatically to the rear wheels. The greater the
your vehicle. A clutch within the torque converter front wheel traction loss, the greater the power
engages automatically at calibrated speeds. This transfer to the rear wheels.
4WD Buttons
may result in a slightly different feeling or response Additionally, on dry pavement under heavy throttle
during normal operation in the upper gears. When input (where one may have no wheel spin), torque 1 — 4WD LOW (Trailhawk models only)
the vehicle speed drops or during some will be sent to the rear in a preemptive effort to 2 — 4WD LOCK
accelerations, the clutch automatically improve vehicle launch and performance
disengages. characteristics.
Enabling Four-Wheel Drive (4x4)
NOTE:
The torque converter clutch will not engage until CAUTION! The buttons for the activation of four-wheel drive
the engine and/or transmission is warm (usually are located on the center console and allow you to
All wheels must have the same size and type select the following:
after 1 to 3 miles [2 to 5 km] of driving). Because tires. Unequal tire sizes must not be used.
the engine speed is higher when the torque Unequal tire size may cause failure of the Power 4WD LOCK
converter clutch is not engaged, it may seem as if Transfer Unit. 4WD LOW — (Trailhawk models only)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 113
Active Drive Control — If Equipped Disabling 4WD LOW consumption, since it allows the disconnect of
The Power Transfer Unit (PTU) is locked to ensure To disable the 4WD LOW mode, the vehicle must the drive shaft where conditions permit.
immediate availability of torque to the rear drive be stationary and the transmission shifted into SNOW: This mode allows you to have greater
axles. This feature is selectable in AUTO mode and NEUTRAL. Push the 4WD LOW button once. stability under conditions of bad weather. For
automatic in the other driving mode. 4WD LOCK use on and off road on surfaces with poor trac-
can be enabled by the following ways: SELEC-TERRAIN — IF EQUIPPED tion, such as roads covered with snow. When in
When the 4WD LOCK button is pushed. SNOW mode (depending on certain operating
Selec-Terrain combines the capabilities of the conditions), the transmission may use SECOND
When the Selec-Terrain switch is moved from vehicle control systems, along with driver input, to gear (rather than FIRST gear) during launches,
AUTO to any other off-road modes. provide the best performance for all terrains. to minimize wheel slippage.
Active Drive With Low Control — (Trailhawk models MODE SELECTION G UIDE SAND/MUD: For off-road driving or use on 4
only) surfaces with poor traction, such as dry sand
The 4WD LOW mode helps to improve the off-road and roads covered by mud or wet grass. The
performance in all modes. To enable 4WD LOW, transmission is set to provide maximum trac-
please follow the steps below: tion.
Enabling 4WD LOW ROCK: (Trailhawk only): This mode is only avail-
With the vehicle stationary, the ignition in the ON/ able in 4WD LOW range. The device sets the
RUN position or with the engine running, shift the vehicle to maximize traction and allow the
transmission into NEUTRAL and push the 4WD highest steering capacity for off-road surfaces.
LOW button once. The instrument cluster will This mode gives you the maximum performance
display the message “4WD LOW” once the shift is off-road. Use for low speed obstacles such as
complete. large rocks, deep ruts, etc.
Selec-Terrain Switch SPORT: This mode is only available in 4WD
NOTE:
AUTO: This four-wheel drive operation is a AUTO, and alters the transmission's automatic
Both LOCK and LOW LED lights will blink and
continuous operation, is fully automatic and can shift schedule for sportier driving. Upshift
then become active on the buttons until the
be used on and off road. This mode balances speeds are increased to make full use of avail-
shift is complete.
traction to ensure maneuverability and acceler- able engine power. Suspension settings are
The instrument cluster display will illuminate the ation improvement compared to a vehicle with optimized and steering assist is modified to
4WD LOW icon. two wheel drive. This mode also reduces fuel provide better handling performance.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 114
NOTE: If the “POWER STEERING SYSTEM HOT - This vehicle has been upgraded with a heavy-duty
ROCK mode is only available on the vehicles PERFORMANCE MAY BE LIMITED” message and an starter, enhanced battery, and other upgraded
equipped with the Off-Road package. icon are displayed on the instrument cluster engine parts, to handle the additional engine
display, it indicates that extreme steering starts.
Activate the Hill Descent Control for steep down-
maneuvers may have occurred, which caused an
hill control Ú page 188. over temperature condition in the electric power AUTOSTOP MODE
steering system. You will lose power steering
POWER STEERING assistance momentarily until the over temperature
The Stop/Start feature is enabled after every
normal customer engine start. At that time, the
The electric power steering system will provide condition no longer exists. Once driving conditions system will go into STOP/START READY.
increased vehicle response and ease of are safe, pull over and let the vehicle idle for a few
To Activate The Autostop Mode, The Following
maneuverability. The electric power steering moments until the light turns off Ú page 77.
Must Occur:
system adapts to different driving conditions. NOTE:
The system must be in STOP/START READY
Even if the power steering system is no longer state. A “STOP/START READY” message will be
WARNING! operational, it is still possible to steer the displayed in the instrument cluster display
Continued operation with reduced assist could vehicle. Under these conditions there will be a within the Stop/Start section Ú page 77.
pose a safety risk to yourself and others. Service substantial increase in steering effort, espe-
The vehicle must be completely stopped.
should be obtained as soon as possible. cially at low speeds and during parking maneu-
vers. The gear selector must be in a forward gear and
the brake pedal pressed.
If the “SERVICE POWER STEERING” or “POWER If the condition persists, see an authorized
STEERING ASSIST OFF - SERVICE SYSTEM” dealer for service. The engine will shut down, the tachometer will
message and a steering wheel icon are displayed move to the zero position, and the Stop/Start
on the instrument cluster display, it indicates that STOP/START SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED telltale will illuminate indicating you are in
Autostop. Customer settings will be maintained
the vehicle needs to be taken to an authorized
The Stop/Start function is developed to reduce upon return to an engine-running condition.
dealer for service. It is likely the vehicle has lost
fuel consumption. The system will stop the engine
power steering assistance Ú page 77.
automatically during a vehicle stop if the required
conditions are met. Releasing the brake pedal or
pressing the accelerator pedal will automatically
restart the engine.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 115
POSSIBLE R EASONS T HE E NGINE DOES Hood is open. Conditions That Will Cause The Engine To Start
Automatically While In Autostop Mode:
N OT AUTOSTOP Vehicle is in 4WD LOW transfer case mode.
Brake pedal is not pressed with sufficient pres- The transmission selector is moved out of
Prior to engine shut down, the system will check DRIVE (D).
sure.
many safety and comfort conditions to see if they
Accelerator pedal input. To maintain cabin temperature comfort.
are fulfilled. Detailed information about the
operation of the Stop/Start system may be viewed Engine temperature is too high. HVAC is set to full defrost mode.
in the instrument cluster display Stop/Start HVAC system temperature or fan speed is
5 mph (8 km/h) threshold has not been
Screen. In the following situations the engine will manually adjusted.
achieved from previous Autostop.
not stop:
Steering angle beyond threshold. Battery voltage drops too low.
Driver’s seat belt is not buckled.
Stop/Start OFF switch is pressed.
4
Adaptive Cruise Control is on and speed is set.
Driver’s door is not closed.
It may be possible for the vehicle to be driven A Stop/Start system error occurs.
Battery temperature is too warm or cold.
several times without the Stop/Start system going Vehicle is in 4WD LOW transfer case mode.
Battery charge is low. into a STOP/START READY state under more Conditions That Force An Application Of The
The vehicle is on a steep grade. extreme conditions of the items listed above. Electric Park Brake While In Autostop Mode:
Cabin heating or cooling is in process and an TO START T HE E NGINE WHILE IN The driver’s door is open and brake pedal
acceptable cabin temperature has not been released.
achieved.
AUTOSTOP MODE
The driver’s door is open and the driver’s seat
HVAC is set to full defrost mode at a high blower While in a forward gear, the engine will start when belt is unbuckled.
speed. the brake pedal is released or the throttle pedal is
pressed. The transmission will automatically The engine hood has been opened.
HVAC is set to MAX A/C.
re-engage upon engine restart. A Stop/Start system error occurs.
Engine has not reached normal operating
If the Electric Park Brake (EPB) is applied with the
temperature. engine off, the engine may require a manual
The transmission is not in a forward gear. restart and the EPB may require a manual release
(press brake pedal and press EPB switch)
Ú page 77.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 116
TO MANUALLY TURN OFF T HE S TOP/ TO MANUALLY TURN ON THE S TOP/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEMS — IF EQUIPPED
S TART S YSTEM S TART S YSTEM Your vehicle may be equipped with the Cruise
Push the Stop/Start OFF switch (located on the Control system, or the Adaptive Cruise Control
switch bank). The light on the switch will turn off. (ACC) system:
Cruise Control will keep your vehicle at a
SYSTEM M ALFUNCTION constant preset speed.
If there is a malfunction in the Stop/Start system, Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) will adjust the
the system will not shut down the engine. A vehicle speed up to the preset speed to main-
“SERVICE STOP/START SYSTEM” message will tain a distance with the vehicle ahead.
appear in the instrument cluster display
NOTE:
Ú page 77.
In vehicles equipped with ACC, if ACC is not
If the “SERVICE STOP/START SYSTEM” message
enabled, Fixed Speed Cruise Control will not
Stop/Start OFF Switch appears in the instrument cluster display, have the
detect vehicles directly ahead of you. Always be
system checked by an authorized dealer.
Push the Stop/Start OFF switch (located on the aware of the feature selected.
switch bank). The light on the switch will illuminate. Only one Cruise Control feature can operate at a
The “STOP/START OFF” message will appear in the time. For example, if Fixed Speed Cruise Control
instrument cluster display and the Autostop mode is enabled, Adaptive Cruise Control will be
will be disabled Ú page 77. unavailable, and vice versa.
NOTE:
The Stop/Start system will reset itself back to an
ON condition every time the ignition is turned off
and back on.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 117
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Menu The instrument cluster display will return to the last When there is a stationary vehicle in front of
display selected after five seconds of no ACC your vehicle in close proximity
The instrument cluster display will show the
display activity. When ESC Full Off Mode is active
current ACC system settings. The information it
displays depends on ACC system status. Activating Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) To Activate/Deactivate
Push the Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) on/off The minimum set speed for the ACC system is Push and release the Adaptive Cruise Control
button until one of the following appears in the 20 mph (32 km/h). (ACC) on/off button. The ACC menu in the
instrument cluster display: When the system is turned on and in the ready instrument cluster display will read “ACC Ready.”
Adaptive Cruise Control Off state, the instrument cluster display will read Then proceed to setting the desired speed as
When ACC is deactivated, the display will read “ACC Ready.” described in the next section.
“Adaptive Cruise Control Off.” When the system is off, the instrument cluster To turn the system off, push and release the
Adaptive Cruise Control Ready display will read “Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) on/off button again.
Off.” At this time, the system will turn off and the
When ACC is activated, but the vehicle speed instrument cluster display will read “Adaptive
setting has not been selected, the display will read NOTE:
You cannot engage ACC under the following condi- Cruise Control (ACC) Off.” The system will also
“Adaptive Cruise Control Ready.” turn off during any of the conditions listed in
tions:
Adaptive Cruise Control Set “To Turn Off” Ú page 121.
When in 4WD Low
When the SET (+) or the SET (-) button is pushed,
the display will read “ACC SET.” When the brakes are applied WARNING!
When ACC is set, the set speed will show in the When the parking brake is applied Leaving the Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
instrument cluster display. When the automatic transmission is in PARK, system on when not in use is dangerous. You
REVERSE or NEUTRAL could accidentally set the system or cause it to
The ACC screen may display once again if any of
go faster than you want. You could lose control
the following ACC activity occurs: When the vehicle speed is below the minimum
and have a collision. Always leave the system off
System Cancel
speed range
when you are not using it.
Driver Override When the brakes are overheated
When the driver’s door is open at low speeds
System Off
ACC Proximity Warning When the driver’s seat belt is unbuckled at low
speeds
ACC Unavailable Warning
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 121
To Set A Desired Speed NOTE: The gear selector is removed from the DRIVE
Fixed Speed Cruise Control cannot be set below position
When the vehicle reaches the speed desired, push
the SET (+) button or the SET (-) button and 20 mph (32 km/h). The Electronic Stability Control/Traction Control
release. The instrument cluster display will show If either system is set when the vehicle speed is System (ESC/TCS) activates
the set speed. above 20 mph (32 km/h), the set speed shall be The vehicle parking brake is applied
the current speed of the vehicle.
NOTE: The Trailer Sway Control (TSC) activates
Fixed Speed Cruise Control can be used without NOTE:
The driver switches ESC to Full Off mode
ACC enabled. To change between the different Keeping your foot on the accelerator pedal can
modes, push the ACC on/off button which turns cause the vehicle to continue to accelerate The braking temperature exceeds normal range
the ACC and the Fixed Speed Cruise Control off. beyond the set speed. If this occurs, the (overheated)
Pushing the Fixed Speed Cruise Control on/off message “DRIVER OVERRIDE” will display in the The following conditions will only cancel the ACC
4
button will result in turning on (changing to) Fixed instrument cluster display. system:
Speed Cruise Control mode. If you continue to accelerate beyond the set Driver seat belt is unbuckled at low speeds
speed while ACC is enabled, the system will not Driver door is opened at low speeds
WARNING!
be controlling the distance between your vehicle
In Fixed Speed Cruise Control mode, the system and the vehicle ahead. The vehicle speed will To Turn Off
will not react to vehicles ahead. In addition, the only be determined by the position of the accel- The system will turn off and clear the set speed in
proximity warning does not activate and no erator pedal. memory if:
alarm will sound even if you are too close to the
To Cancel The Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) on/off button
vehicle ahead since neither the presence of the
The following conditions cancel the ACC or Fixed is pushed
vehicle ahead nor the vehicle-to-vehicle distance
is detected. Be sure to maintain a safe distance Speed Cruise Control systems: The Fixed Speed Cruise Control on/off button is
between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead. The brake pedal is applied pushed
Always be aware which mode is selected. The ignition is placed in the OFF position
The CANC (cancel) button is pushed
The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) activates 4WD Low is engaged
If ACC is set when the vehicle speed is below
20 mph (32 km/h), the set speed will default to
20 mph (32 km/h).
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 122
Setting The Following Distance In ACC To decrease the distance setting, push the instrument cluster display and a chime will sound
Distance Decrease button and release. Each time while ACC continues to apply its maximum braking
The specified following distance for ACC can be set
the button is pushed, the distance setting force.
by varying the distance setting between four bars
decreases by one bar (shorter). NOTE:
(longest), three bars (long), two bars (medium) and
one bar (short). Using this distance setting and the If a slower moving vehicle is detected in the same The “BRAKE!” screen in the instrument cluster
vehicle speed, ACC calculates and sets the lane, the instrument cluster display will show the display is a warning for the driver to take action
distance to the vehicle ahead. This distance ACC Set With Target Detected Light. The system and does not necessarily mean that the Forward
setting will show in the instrument cluster display. will then adjust vehicle speed automatically to Collision Warning system is applying the brakes
maintain the distance setting, regardless of the set autonomously.
speed. Overtake Aid
The vehicle will then maintain the set distance 4
When driving with Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
until: engaged and following a vehicle, the system will
The vehicle ahead accelerates to a speed above provide an additional acceleration up to the ACC
the set speed. set speed to assist in passing the vehicle. This
The vehicle ahead moves out of your lane or additional acceleration is triggered when the driver
view of the sensor. utilizes the left turn signal and will only be active
when passing on the left hand side.
The distance setting is changed.
The system disengages Ú page 120.
ACC Operation At Stop
Distance Settings In the event that the ACC system brings your
The maximum braking applied by ACC is limited;
1 — Longest Distance Setting (Four Bars) vehicle to a standstill while following a vehicle in
however, the driver can always apply the brakes
front, if the vehicle in front starts moving within two
2 — Medium Distance Setting (Two Bars) manually, if necessary.
seconds of your vehicle coming to a standstill, your
3 — Long Distance Setting (Three Bars) NOTE: vehicle will resume motion without the need for
4 — Short Distance Setting (One Bar) The brake lights will illuminate whenever the ACC any driver action.
system applies the brakes.
If the vehicle in front does not start moving within
To increase the distance setting, push the A Proximity Warning will alert the driver if ACC two seconds of your vehicle coming to a standstill,
Distance Increase button and release. Each time predicts that its maximum braking level is not the driver will either have to push the RES (resume)
the button is pushed, the distance setting sufficient to maintain the set distance. If this button, or apply the accelerator pedal to reengage
increases by one bar (longer). occurs, a visual alert “BRAKE!” will flash in the the ACC to the existing set speed.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 124
NOTE: obstructions, such as mud, dirt or ice. In these If the sensor or front end of the vehicle is
After the ACC system holds your vehicle at a stand- cases, the instrument cluster display will display damaged due to a collision, see an authorized
still for approximately three consecutive minutes, the above message and the system will deactivate. dealer for service.
the parking brake will be activated, and the ACC This message can sometimes be displayed while Do not attach or install any accessories near the
system will be cancelled. driving in highly reflective areas (i.e. ice and snow, sensor, including transparent material or after-
While ACC is holding your vehicle at a standstill, if or tunnels with reflective tiles). The ACC system will market grilles. Doing so could cause an ACC
the driver seat belt is unbuckled or the driver door recover after the vehicle has left these areas. system failure or malfunction.
is opened, the parking brake will be activated, and Under rare conditions, when the radar is not When the condition that deactivated the system is
the ACC system will be cancelled. tracking any vehicles or objects in its path this no longer present, the system will return to the
warning may temporarily occur. “Adaptive Cruise Control Off” state and will resume
WARNING!
NOTE: function by simply reactivating it.
When the ACC system is resumed, the driver If the “ACC Unavailable Wipe Front Radar Sensor” NOTE:
must ensure that there are no pedestrians, warning is active, Fixed Speed Cruise Control is still
If the “ACC Unavailable Wipe Front Radar
vehicles or objects in the path of the vehicle. available.
Sensor” message occurs frequently (e.g. more
Failure to follow these warnings can result in a If weather conditions are not a factor, the driver than once on every trip) without any snow, rain,
collision and death or serious personal injury. should examine the sensor. It may require cleaning mud, or other obstruction, have the radar
or removal of an obstruction. The sensor is located sensor realigned at an authorized dealer.
Display Warnings And Maintenance in the center of the vehicle behind the lower grille.
Installing a snow plow, front-end protector, an
To keep the ACC system operating properly, it is aftermarket grille or modifying the grille is not
“WIPE FRONT RADAR SENSOR IN FRONT OF important to note the following maintenance recommended. Doing so may block the sensor
VEHICLE” WARNING items: and inhibit ACC operation.
The “ACC Unavailable Wipe Front Radar Sensor” Always keep the sensor clean. Carefully wipe the
warning will display and a chime will sound when sensor lens with a soft cloth. Be cautious not to
conditions temporarily limit system performance. damage the sensor lens.
This most often occurs at times of poor visibility, Do not remove any screws from the sensor.
such as in snow or heavy rain. The ACC system may Doing so could cause an ACC system malfunc-
also become temporarily blinded due to tion or failure and require a sensor realignment.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 125
“CLEAN FRONT WINDSHIELD” WARNING When the condition that created limited TOWING A TRAILER
functionality is no longer present, the system will
The “ACC Limited Functionality Clean Front Towing a trailer is not recommended when
return to full functionality.
Windshield” warning will display and a chime will using ACC.
sound when conditions temporarily limit system NOTE:
performance. This most often occurs at times of If the “ACC Limited Functionality Clean Front Wind- OFFSET DRIVING
poor visibility, such as in snow or heavy rain and shield” message occurs frequently (e.g. more than ACC may not detect a vehicle in the same lane that
fog. The ACC system may also become temporarily once on every trip) without any snow, rain, mud, or is offset from your direct line of travel, or a vehicle
blinded due to obstructions, such as mud, dirt, or other obstruction, have the windshield and forward merging in from a side lane. There may not be
ice on windshield and fog on the inside of glass. In facing camera inspected at an authorized dealer. sufficient distance to the vehicle ahead. The offset
these cases, the instrument cluster display will vehicle may move in and out of the line of travel,
read “ACC Limited Functionality Clean Front SERVICE ACC WARNING which can cause your vehicle to brake or 4
Windshield” and the system will have degraded If the system turns off, and the instrument cluster accelerate unexpectedly.
performance. display reads “ACC Unavailable Service Required”
This message can sometimes be displayed while or “Cruise Unavailable Service Required”, there
driving in adverse weather conditions. The ACC may be an internal system fault or a temporary
system will recover after the vehicle has left these malfunction that limits ACC functionality. Although
areas. Under rare conditions, when the camera is the vehicle is still drivable under normal
not tracking any vehicles or objects in its path this conditions, ACC will be temporarily unavailable. If
warning may temporarily occur. this occurs, try activating ACC again later, following
an ignition cycle. If the problem persists, see an
If weather conditions are not a factor, the driver
authorized dealer.
should examine the windshield and the camera
located on the back side of the inside rearview Precautions While Driving With ACC
mirror. They may require cleaning or removal of an In certain driving situations, ACC may have
obstruction. Offset Driving Condition Example
detection issues. In these cases, ACC may brake
late or unexpectedly. The driver needs to stay alert
and may need to intervene. The following are
examples of these types of situations:
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 126
NOTE: NOTE:
Whenever an audible alert is requested by the TSA Supplemental information will not be displayed
system, the radio is also muted. when the vehicle is ONLY equipped with GPS.
TSA Off Speed Limit Exceeded
When the TSA system is turned off, the system will When the vehicle’s speed exceeds the displayed
not show any traffic signs (unless selected in the speed limit by 3 mph (5 km/h), the speed limit sign
HOME screen, which will show detected speed on the instrument cluster display will show a
limit signs), and no alerts will be issued to the red outline to alert the driver.
driver.
CAUTION!
I NDICATIONS ON THE D ISPLAY Traffic Signs Recognized
Functionality may be limited or the system
Detected traffic signs are shown in the instrument 1 — Current Speed Limit With Supplemental Infor- may not work if the sensor is obstructed.
cluster display, and can display any combination of mation (School Zone)
signs at one time (e.g. speed limit, speed limit and The system may have limited operation or not
2 — Next Speed Limit Detected work at all in weather conditions such as
supplemental info, and “Do Not Pass” signs)
3 — No Passing Zone Detected heavy rain, hail, and thick fog. Strong light
depending on what information is available.
contrasts can influence the recognition capa-
When a newly detected speed limit is higher than bility of the sensor.
the current speed limit, the display will update Supplemental Information
along with an up arrow. Supplemental information may be displayed along The area surrounding the sensor must not be
with a newly detected speed limit indicating covered with stickers or any other object.
When a newly detected speed limit is lower than
the current speed limit, the display will update special circumstances the driver should be aware Do not tamper or perform any operations in
along with a down arrow. of. Available supplemental information includes: the area of the windshield glass directly
School surrounding the sensor.
NOTE:
Up or down arrows will be displayed for up to five Construction Clean foreign matters such as bird droppings,
seconds. Rain insects, snow or ice on the windshield. Use
Snow
specific detergents and clean cloths to avoid
scratching the windshield.
Fog
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 129
HIGHWAY ASSIST SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED HAS uses sensors within the steering wheel to
measure driver attentiveness. HAS requires the WARNING!
OPERATION driver’s hands on the steering wheel at all times. You should turn off the Highway Assist system:
The system will generally aim to keep the vehicle
The Highway Assist system (HAS) is combined with centered in the lane, but when the driver turns the When driving in complex driving situations
the Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) system, and steering wheel (e.g. to move further away from a (e.g. urban environments, construction zones,
centers the vehicle in the driving lane while large vehicle in the next lane) the system will etc.), adverse weather (e.g. rain, snow, fog,
traveling on controlled access highways at speeds reduce its control and enter "co-steering" mode. sleet, dust), or adverse road conditions
up to 90 mph (145 km/h). While in co-steering mode, the system will provide (e.g. heavy traffic, worn or missing lane
reduced assistance and allow the driver to control markings, etc.).
For ACC system operating instructions and system
limitations, see Ú page 118. the path of the vehicle. Once the driver stops When entering a highway off ramp, when 4
providing input to the steering wheel, the system driving on roads that are, icy, snow covered, or
NOTE: will require a few seconds to fully resume lane slippery.
The driver should always obey traffic laws and centering assistance, especially during curves.
speed limits. Never drive above applicable When circumstances do not allow safe driving
speed limit restrictions. WARNING! at a constant speed.
The driver can override HAS at any time by The Highway Assist system is a convenience
braking, accelerating, or steering the vehicle. system. It is not a substitute for active driver
Just like ACC, HAS will maintain a set speed as long involvement. It is always the driver’s
as the set distance between your vehicle and the responsibility to be attentive of road traffic,
vehicle in front is maintained. HAS will also keep weather conditions, vehicle speed, distance to
your vehicle centered between the lane lines, and the vehicle ahead, position in the lane compared
monitor for other vehicles in adjacent lanes by to other vehicles, and brake operation to ensure
utilizing the Blind Spot Monitoring sensors. safe operation of the vehicle under all road
conditions. Your complete attention is always
required while driving to maintain safe control of
your vehicle. Failure to follow these warnings can
result in a collision and death or serious
personal injury.
(Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 130
TURNING HIGHWAY ASSIST ON O R O FF 3. If ACC was not active before pushing the HAS NOTE:
on/off button, push the SET (+) button or the Along with the color change of the steering wheel
SET (-) button and release when the desired image, the “glow” effect of the instrument cluster
highway driving speed is shown in the display will also change to green when HAS is
instrument cluster display. engaged.
4. If desired, adjust the ACC distance setting by System Engagement Conditions
pushing the Distance Increase or Distance The following conditions must be met after
Decrease buttons. enabling the Highway Assist system before the
system will engage:
When all system conditions are met as described
in “System Engagement Conditions” in the next System is turned on
section, the system will engage and the steering ACC is active
Highway Assist On/Off Button wheel image in the display will change to green. Driver seat belt is buckled
To enable the Highway Assist system, proceed as Vehicle is driving on an approved controlled
follows: access highway
1. Push the Highway Assist on/off button System detects visible lane markings
located on the right side of the steering Vehicle is traveling below 90 mph (145 km/h)
wheel. The steering wheel image will display Vehicle is centered in lane
white in the instrument cluster display until
the system is engaged. If ACC was previously Turn signal is not activated
disabled, pushing this button will activate Vehicle is not in a tight curve
BOTH ACC and Highway Assist systems. Trailer is not connected
2. If ACC was active and engaged before pushing Driver has hands on steering wheel
Highway Assist Engaged (Steering Wheel Green)
the HAS on/off button, ACC will remain engaged
and HAS will become enabled and then
engaged (once all other conditions are met).
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 131
NOTE: If a turn signal is used (unless a target is in the I NDICATIONS ON THE D ISPLAY
For the system to detect the driver’s hands on the blind spot zone on the same side the turn signal
steering wheel, the wheel must be gripped on the is being applied) The Highway Assist system status can always be
outside. Gripping the inside areas of the steering viewed in the instrument cluster display, and
If the driver applies enough input to the steering
wheel will not satisfy the hands-on condition to status changes are shown by changes in color of
wheel
engage the system. the system’s indicator lights.
If the driver’s seat belt is released
As the system detects driver inattentiveness as
If the vehicle speed exceeds 90 mph (145 km/h) previously described Ú page 129, the system
If the Highway Assist on/off button is pushed status indicator lights will change from green, to
again (HAS will turn off) yellow, to red, while the steering wheel icon on the
If the Forward Collision Warning (FCW) system
display moves up the screen to the center. The 4
following indicators will change in color as
becomes active and is providing warnings/
warnings to the driver escalate:
braking
Highway Assist Indicator (steering wheel icon in
NOTE:
the instrument cluster display)
HAS will not enable if the system detects a
Glow effect of the instrument cluster display
trailer is connected to the vehicle.
Do Not Grip Inside Of Steering Wheel If driver attention is not returned, the system will
Pushing the Highway Assist on/off button will
deactivate.
System Deactivation turn the system off. All other deactivation condi-
tions will place the system back into the enabled Highway Assist Indicators Are Off
The system will be deactivated in any of the state with the steering wheel indicator displayed HAS is not turned on/enabled by the driver.
following situations: in white until all engagement conditions are met
If the system has detected driver inattentive-
Highway Assist Indicators Are White
again.
ness, and has gone through all escalation warn- HAS is turned on/enabled by the driver, but the
When the system is deactivated, the system
ings after hands are no longer detected on the system is not actively steering to the vehicle.
status indicator lights will turn off, Active Lane
steering wheel Management will return to its previous state, Highway Assist Indicators Are Green
If lane markings are no longer detected and ACC will disable. System is actively steering the vehicle and the
If the brake pedal is pressed or ACC system is system detects driver is attentive.
deactivated
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 132
Highway Assist is an SAE Level 2 Driver Assist Merge onto highways or exit off-ramps
feature, requiring driver attention at all times. Change lanes or turn
To prevent serious injury or death: React to cross traffic
Always remain alert and be ready to take NOTE:
control of the vehicle in the event that the Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) is a core component
Highway Assist system disables. of the Highway Assist system. For ACC system
Always keep your hands on the steering wheel limitations Ú page 118.
when the Highway Assist system is activated.
Do not use a hand-held device when the
Highway Assist Cancelled Message Highway Assist system is engaged.
Maintain a safe distance from other vehicles
and pay attention to traffic conditions.
(Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 133
The Highway Assist system may have limited or ParkSense will retain the last system state PARKSENSE WARNING DISPLAY
reduced functionality when one of the following (enabled or disabled) from the last ignition cycle
conditions occur: when the ignition is changed to the ON/RUN The ParkSense Warning screen will only be
position. displayed if “Sound and Display” is selected from
The vehicle’s radar sensors and/or forward
the Customer - Programmable Features section of
facing camera is damaged, covered, misaligned, ParkSense is active in DRIVE or REVERSE, as long
the Uconnect system Ú page 165.
or obstructed (e.g. by mud, ice, snow, etc.) as the system is on. The system will remain active
until the vehicle speed is increased to The ParkSense Warning screen is located within
Driving near highway toll booths
approximately 7 mph (11 km/h) or above. While in the instrument cluster display Ú page 77. It
NOTE: REVERSE and above the system's operating speed, provides visual warnings to indicate the distance
If damage to the windshield occurs, have the a warning will appear in the instrument cluster between the rear fascia/bumper and/or front
windshield replaced by an authorized dealer as display indicating the vehicle speed is too fast. The fascia/bumper and the detected obstacle. 4
soon as possible. system will become active again if the vehicle
speed is decreased to speeds less than
PARKSENSE DISPLAY
PARKSENSE FRONT/REAR PARK ASSIST approximately 6 mph (9 km/h). The warning display will turn on indicating the
SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED PARKSENSE SENSORS
system status when the vehicle is in REVERSE or
when the vehicle is in DRIVE and an obstacle has
The ParkSense Park Assist system provides visual The six ParkSense sensors (four when vehicle is been detected.
and audible indications of the distance between not equipped with front sensors), located in the The system will indicate a detected obstacle by
the rear, and if equipped, the front fascia/bumper rear fascia/bumper, and the six ParkSense showing a single arc in the left and/or right front or
and a detected obstacle when backing up or sensors located in the front fascia/bumper, rear regions based on the object’s distance and
moving forward (e.g. during a parking maneuver). monitor the area in front and behind the vehicle location relative to the vehicle.
NOTE: that is within the sensors’ field of view. The front If an object is detected in the left and/or right rear
The system is provided to assist the driver and
sensors detect obstacles from approximately region, the display will show a single arc in the
not to substitute the driver. 12 inches (30 cm) up to 47 inches (120 cm) from left and/or right rear region and the system will
the front fascia/bumper. The rear sensors can produce a tone. As the vehicle moves closer to the
The driver must stay in full control of the detect obstacles from approximately 12 inches
vehicle's acceleration and braking and is object, the display will show the single arc moving
(30 cm) up to 79 inches (200 cm) from the rear closer to the vehicle and the tone will change from
responsible for controlling the vehicle's move- fascia/bumper. These distances depend on the
ments Ú page 137. a single 1/2 second tone to slow, to fast, to
location, type and orientation of the obstacle in the continuous.
horizontal direction.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 134
The vehicle is close to the obstacle when the instrument cluster display shows one flashing arc and sounds a continuous tone. The following chart shows the
warning alert operation when the system is detecting an obstacle:
SERVICE THE PARKSENSE PARK ASSIST PARKSENSE SYSTEM U SAGE terpreting a close object as a sensor problem,
causing the “ParkSense Unavailable Service
SYSTEM PRECAUTIONS Required” message to be displayed in the
During vehicle start up, when the ParkSense NOTE: instrument cluster display.
System has detected a faulted condition, the Ensure that the front and rear fascias/bumpers NOTE:
instrument cluster will actuate a single chime, are free of snow, ice, mud, dirt and debris to If any objects are attached to the bumper within a
once per ignition cycle, and it will display the keep the ParkSense system operating properly. 6.5 ft (2 m) field of view, they will interfere and
"PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED" cause false alerts and possibly blockage.
Jackhammers, large trucks, and other vibrations
message for five seconds.
could affect the performance of ParkSense. There may be a delay in the object detection
If "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE REAR rate if the object is moving.
When you turn ParkSense off, the instrument 4
SENSORS" or "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE
cluster display will read “PARKSENSE OFF.” The rear sensors are automatically deactivated
FRONT SENSORS" appears in the instrument
Furthermore, once you turn ParkSense off, it when the trailer’s electric plug is inserted in the
cluster display make sure the outer surface and
remains off until you turn it on again, even if you vehicle’s tow socket. The front sensors stay
the underside of the rear fascia/bumper and/or
cycle the ignition. active and can provide acoustic and visual
front fascia/bumper is clean and clear of snow,
warnings. The rear sensors are automatically
ice, mud, dirt or other obstruction and then cycle ParkSense, when on, will reduce the volume of
reactivated when the trailer's cable plug is
the ignition. If the message continues to appear the radio when it is sounding a tone.
removed.
see an authorized dealer. Clean the ParkSense sensors regularly, taking
If the "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE care not to scratch or damage them. The WARNING!
REQUIRED" message appears in the instrument sensors must not be covered with ice, snow,
slush, mud, dirt or debris. Failure to do so can Drivers must be careful when backing up even
cluster display, see an authorized dealer.
result in the system not working properly. The when using ParkSense. Always check carefully
CLEANING THE PARKSENSE SYSTEM ParkSense system might not detect an obstacle behind your vehicle, look behind you, and be
behind or in front of the fascia/bumper, or it sure to check for pedestrians, animals, other
Clean the ParkSense sensors with water, car wash vehicles, obstructions, and blind spots before
soap and a soft cloth. Do not use rough or hard could provide a false indication that an obstacle
is behind or in front of the fascia/bumper. backing up. You are responsible for safety and
cloths. Do not scratch or poke the sensors. must continue to pay attention to your
Otherwise, you could damage the sensors. Use the ParkSense switch to turn the ParkSense surroundings. Failure to do so can result in
system off if objects such as bicycle carriers, serious injury or death.
etc. are attached to the rear fascia/bumper.
Failure to do so can result in the system misin- (Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 138
WARNING!
SIDE D ISTANCE WARNING (SDW) NOTE:
ParkSense will reduce the volume of the radio if on
Before using ParkSense, it is strongly recom-
SYSTEM when the system is sounding an audible tone.
mended that the ball mount and hitch ball The Side Distance Warning system has the Activation/Deactivation
assembly be disconnected from the vehicle function of detecting the presence of side
The system can operate only after driving a short
when the vehicle is not used for towing. Failure obstacles near the vehicle using the parking
distance and if the vehicle speed is between 0 and
to do so can result in injury or damage to vehi- sensors located in the front and rear bumpers.
7 mph (0 and 11 km/h). The system can be
cles or obstacles because the hitch ball will be
Side Distance Warning Display activated/deactivated via the "Settings" menu of
much closer to the obstacle than the rear
The Side Distance Warning screen will only be the Uconnect system. If the ParkSense System is
fascia when the vehicle sounds the continuous
displayed if this feature is enabled within Uconnect deactivated via the ParkSense switch, then the
tone. Also, the sensors could detect the ball
Settings Ú page 165. side distance warning system will automatically be
mount and hitch ball assembly, depending on
deactivated.
its size and shape, giving a false indication that The system warns the driver with an acoustic
an obstacle is behind the vehicle. signal and when selected, with visual indications
on the instrument panel display Ú page 77.
CAUTION!
Park Assist system is capable of maneuvering a ENABLING A ND DISABLING T HE
vehicle into a parallel or a perpendicular parking
ParkSense is only a parking aid and it is space on either side (i.e., driver side or passenger PARKSENSE ACTIVE PARK ASSIST
unable to recognize every obstacle, including side), as well as exiting a parallel parking space. SYSTEM
small obstacles. Parking curbs might be NOTE: The ParkSense Active Park Assist system
temporarily detected or not detected at all.
The driver is always responsible for controlling can be enabled and disabled with the
Obstacles located above or below the sensors
the vehicle, responsible for any surrounding ParkSense Active Park Assist switch,
will not be detected when they are in close
objects, and must intervene as required. located on the switch panel below the
proximity.
The system is designed to assist the driver and
Uconnect display.
The vehicle must be driven slowly when using not to substitute the driver. To enable or disable the ParkSense Active Park
ParkSense in order to be able to stop in time Assist system, push the ParkSense Active Park
when an obstacle is detected. It is recom- During a semi-automatic maneuver, if the driver
touches the steering wheel after being Assist switch once (LED turns on). Pushing the
mended that the driver looks over his/her switch a second time will disable the system
shoulder when using ParkSense. instructed to remove their hands from the
steering wheel, the system will cancel, and the (LED turns off).
driver will be required to manually complete the The ParkSense Active Park Assist system will turn
PARKSENSE ACTIVE PARK ASSIST SYSTEM — parking maneuver. off automatically for any of the following
conditions:
The system may not work in all conditions
IF EQUIPPED (e.g. environmental conditions such as heavy Parking maneuver is complete.
The ParkSense Active Park Assist system is rain, snow, etc., or if searching for a parking Vehicle speed is greater than 18 mph
intended to assist the driver during parallel, space that has surfaces that will absorb the (30 km/h) when searching for a parking space.
perpendicular, and parallel park exit maneuvers by ultrasonic sensor waves).
Vehicle speed is greater than 5 mph (7 km/h)
identifying a proper parking space, providing New vehicles from the dealer must have at least during active steering guidance into the parking
audible/visual instructions, and controlling the 30 miles (48 km) accumulated before the Park- space.
steering wheel. The ParkSense Active Park Assist Sense Active Park Assist system is fully cali-
system is defined as “semi-automatic” since the Steering Wheel is touched during active
brated and performs accurately. This is due to
driver maintains control of the accelerator, gear the system’s dynamic vehicle calibration to steering guidance into the parking space.
selector and brakes. Depending on the driver's improve the performance of the feature. ParkSense Park Assist switch is pushed.
parking maneuver selection, the ParkSense Active
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 141
be overhanging or protruding into the parking Once the vehicle is in position, you will be
space (e.g., ladders, tailgates, etc. from instructed to stop the vehicle’s movement and
surrounding objects/vehicles). remove your hands from the steering wheel. When
When searching for a parking space, the driver the vehicle comes to a standstill (your hands still
should drive as parallel or perpendicular removed from the steering wheel), you will be
(depending on the type of maneuver) to other instructed to place the gear selector into the
vehicles as possible. REVERSE position.
The feature will only indicate the last detected The system may then instruct the driver to wait for
parking space (example: if passing multiple steering to complete before then instructing to
available parking spaces, the system will only check surroundings and move backward.
indicate the last detected parking space for the Move Backward Into Perpendicular Parking Space
maneuver). The system may instruct several more gear shifts
When an available parking space has been found, (DRIVE and REVERSE), with hands off of the
and the vehicle is not in position, you will be steering wheel, before instructing the driver to
instructed to move forward to position the vehicle check surroundings and complete the parking
for a perpendicular or parallel parking sequence maneuver.
(depending on the type of maneuver being When the vehicle is in the parking position, the
performed). maneuver is complete and the driver will be
instructed to check the vehicle's parking position,
then shift the vehicle into PARK. The message
Move Backward Into Parallel Parking Space "Active ParkSense Complete - Check Parking
Position" will be displayed momentarily.
The sensors may not detect objects of a partic- Some maneuvers at very tight bends might be Monitoring sensors to detect vehicles in adjacent
ular shape or made from particular materials impossible to be carried out. lanes while the driver is preparing to change lanes.
(very thin poles, trailer beams, panels, nets, Take great care to ensure that conditions do not The system is operational at speeds above 37 mph
bushes, anti-parking posts, pavements, rubbish change during the parking maneuver (e.g. if (60 km/h) and below 112 mph (180 km/h).
bins, motor vehicles, etc.). Always take great there are persons and/or animals in the parking
care to check that the vehicle and its path are When both lane markings are detected, and the
place, moving vehicles, etc.) and intervene vehicle drifts out of the lane (no turn signal
actually compatible with the parking place iden- immediately if necessary.
tified by the system. applied), the Active Lane Management system
During parking maneuvers, pay attention to vehi- provides a visual warning in the instrument cluster,
The use of wheels and tires that are different cles approaching from the opposite direction. as well as a steering assist torque (if configured in
size to the original equipment could affect the Always abide by the law and road regulations. Uconnect Settings), to prompt the driver to remain
operation of the system. within the lane boundaries. If the driver continues 4
NOTE:
The operation of the rear sensors is automati- to drift out of the lane, the system provides a
Correct system operation is not guaranteed if
cally deactivated when the trailer's electric plug flashing visual warning through the instrument
is inserted in the vehicle's tow hook socket, snow chains or the compact spare tire are fitted. cluster display as well as a haptic steering wheel
while the front sensors stay active and can The function only informs the driver about the vibration (if configured in Uconnect Settings) when
provide acoustic and visual warnings. If this situ- last appropriate parking place (parallel or the vehicle crosses the lane boundary.
ation occurs, Active Park Assist will not work. perpendicular) detected by the parking sensors. The warning will be in the form of a vibration in the
The rear sensors are automatically reactivated Some messages displayed are accompanied by steering wheel, and/or automatic steering
when the trailer's cable plug is removed. acoustic warnings. assistance to direct the vehicle back toward the
In "Search in Progress" mode, the system could center of the lane.
incorrectly identify a parking place to carry out ACTIVE LANE MANAGEMENT SYSTEM — When both lane markings are detected, and the
the maneuver (e.g. by a junction, driveways,
roads crossing the direction of travel, etc.). IF EQUIPPED driver uses the turn signal to indicate a lane
change while the system detects another vehicle in
In the case of parking maneuvers on roads with ACTIVE LANE M ANAGEMENT OPERATION the Blind Spot Monitoring zone on that side of the
inclines, the performance of the system could vehicle, the Active Lane Management system
be inferior and it may deactivate. The Active Lane Management (ALM) system uses a provides a warning in the form of steering assist
forward facing camera to detect lane markings or and/or steering vibration (depending on radio
If a parking maneuver is being carried out
road edges and measure vehicle position within settings) to guide the vehicle back to the center of
between two parked vehicles alongside a curb,
the lane boundaries. It also uses the Blind Spot the lane.
the system may cause the vehicle to drive up
onto the curb.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 146
Depending on the type of warning selected, the NOTE: ACTIVE LANE MANAGEMENT WARNING
system will either guide the vehicle back to the When operating conditions have been met, the
center of the lane, provide a vibration in the Active Lane Management system will monitor if the
MESSAGE
steering wheel, or both. driver’s hands are on the steering wheel and The Active Lane Management system will indicate
NOTE: provides an audible and visual warning to the the current lane drift condition through the
For an event where the Active Lane Management driver if removed. The system will cancel if the instrument cluster display.
system is reacting to a target vehicle in the driver does not return their hands to the wheel.
When the system is on, the lane lines are gray
adjacent lane, the steering vibration will occur as TURNING ACTIVE LANE MANAGEMENT when both of the lane boundaries have not been
soon as the vehicle starts to depart the center of its detected.
lane (as opposed to waiting until the lane marker is ON O R O FF
crossed), the Blind Spot Monitoring indicator LED The Active Lane Management button is
on the mirror will flash, and the steering wheel located on the switch panel below the
torque will be greater than for a normal lane Uconnect display.
departure (no vehicle in adjacent lane).
To turn the system on, push the Active Lane
The driver may manually override the steering Management button (LED turns off). A message is
assist warning by applying force into the steering shown in the instrument cluster display.
wheel at any time.
To turn the system off, push the button again
When only a single lane marking is detected and the (LED turns on).
driver drifts across the lane marking (no turn signal
applied), the Active Lane Management system NOTE:
provides a visual warning in the instrument cluster, The Active Lane Management system will retain System On (Gray Lines)
as well as a steering assist torque (if configured in the last system state on or off from the last ignition
Uconnect Settings), to prompt the driver to remain cycle when the ignition is placed in the ON/RUN
within the lane boundaries. If the driver continues to position.
drift out of the lane, the system provides a flashing
visual warning through the instrument cluster
display as well as a haptic steering wheel vibration
(if configured in Uconnect Settings) when the
vehicle crosses the lane boundary.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 147
Left Lane Departure — Only Left Lane Detected Left Lane Departure — Both Lanes Detected When the system senses a lane drift situation,
When the system is on and only the left lane When the system is on, the lane lines turn from the left lane line turns solid yellow. At this time,
marking has been detected, and the system is gray to green to indicate that both of the lane steering assist warning is applied to the steering
ready to provide visual warnings in the instru- markings have been detected. When both lane wheel in the opposite direction of the lane
ment cluster display if a lane departure occurs, markings have been detected, the system is boundary.
the left lane line will be green. ready to provide visual warnings in the instru- For example: If approaching the left side of the
When the system senses the lane line has been ment cluster display and a vibration and/or lane the steering wheel will turn to the right.
approached (but not crossed), the left lane line steering assist warning in the steering wheel if a
will change to solid yellow. lane departure occurs.
When the system senses the lane line is being
4
crossed, the left lane line will change to flashing
yellow.
SURROUND VIEW CAMERA SYSTEM — When the vehicle is shifted out of REVERSE with
camera delay turned on, the camera image will
Modes Of Operation
Manual activation of the Surround View Camera is
IF EQUIPPED continue to be displayed for up to 10 seconds selected by pressing the Surround View Camera
unless the vehicle speed exceeds 8 mph (13 km/h), soft key located in the Controls menu within the
Your vehicle may be equipped with the Surround the vehicle is shifted into PARK or the ignition is
View Camera system that allows you to see an Uconnect system.
placed in the OFF position. There is a touchscreen
on-screen image of the surroundings and Top View button X to disable the display of the camera image. Top View
of your vehicle whenever the gear selector is put The Top View will show in the Uconnect system with
into REVERSE or a different view is selected When the vehicle is shifted out of REVERSE with
camera delay turned off, the Surround View Rear View or Front View in a split screen display.
through the touchscreen soft buttons. The Top There are integrated ParkSense arcs in the image
View of the vehicle will show which doors are open. Camera mode is exited and the last known screen
appears again. at the front and rear of the vehicle. The arcs will
The image will be displayed on the touchscreen change color from yellow to red corresponding the
display along with a caution note “Check Entire When enabled, active guidelines are overlaid on distance zones to the oncoming object.
Surroundings” across the top of the screen. the image to illustrate the width of the vehicle,
After five seconds, this note will disappear. The including the side view mirrors and its projected
Surround View Camera system is comprised of four backup path based on the steering wheel position.
sequential cameras located in the front grille, rear Different colored zones indicate the distance to
liftgate and side mirrors. the rear of the vehicle.
NOTE: The following table shows the approximate
The Surround View Camera system has program- distances for each zone:
mable settings that may be selected through the
Uconnect system Ú page 165. Distance To The Rear Of
Zone
Press this button on the touchscreen to The Vehicle
enter the Surround View Camera menu in Red 0 - 1 ft (0 - 30 cm)
the Uconnect system. Surround View Camera View
Yellow 1 ft - 6.5 ft (30 cm - 2 m)
When the vehicle is shifted into REVERSE, the Rear
6.5 ft or greater
View and Top View is the default view of the Green
(2 m or greater)
system.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 151
NOTE: Front Cross Path View The vehicle is in any gear other than REVERSE
Front tires will be in image when the tires are Pressing the Front Cross Path soft key and the X button is pressed.
turned. will give the driver a wider angle view of The camera delay system is turned off manually
Due to wide angle cameras in the mirrors, the the front camera system. The Top View through the Uconnect Settings menu
image will appear distorted. will be disabled when this is selected. Ú page 165.
Top View will show which doors are open. Rear View Camera NOTE:
Open front doors will cancel outside image. Pressing the Back Up Camera soft key If snow, ice, mud, or any foreign substance
will provide a full screen rear view with builds up on the camera lenses, clean the
Open liftgate will cancel rear image while in lenses, rinse with water, and dry with a soft
Zoom View.
Top View. cloth. Do not cover the lenses.
Rear View Plus Top View
4
NOTE: If a malfunction with the system has occurred,
This is the default view of the system in If the Rear View Camera view was selected through see an authorized dealer.
REVERSE and is always paired with the the Surround View Camera menu, exiting out of the
Top View of the vehicle with optional Rear View screen will return to the last known WARNING!
active guidelines for the projected path Surround View screen. If the Back Up Camera was Drivers must be careful when backing up even
when enabled. manually activated through the Controls menu of when using the Surround View Camera. Always
Rear Cross Path View the Uconnect system, exiting out of the display check carefully behind your vehicle, and be sure
screen will return to the Controls menu. to check for pedestrians, animals, other
Pressing the Rear Cross Path soft key will
give the driver a wider angle view of the Deactivation vehicles, obstructions, or blind spots before
rear camera system. The Top View will be The system can be deactivated under the following backing up. You are responsible for the safety of
disabled when this is selected conditions: your surroundings and must continue to pay
attention while backing up. Failure to do so can
Front View Plus Top View The speed of the vehicle is greater than 8 mph
result in serious injury or death.
The Front View will show you what is (13 km/h).
immediately in front of the vehicle and is The vehicle is shifted into PARK.
always paired with the Top View of the
vehicle.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 152
Pressing the icon a second time will There is no fuel filler cap. Two flapper doors inside 2. Insert the fuel nozzle fully into the filler pipe;
return the view to the standard Back Up the pipe seal the system. the nozzle opens and holds the flapper door
Camera display. 1. Open the fuel filler door by pushing on the while refueling.
outer edge of the fuel door. 3. Fill the vehicle with fuel, and when the fuel
nozzle “clicks” or shuts off, the fuel tank is full.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 153
4. Keep the nozzle in the filler for five seconds This label contains the month and year of suspension components sometimes specified by
after nozzle clicks to allow fuel to drain from manufacture, Gross Vehicle Weight Rating purchasers for increased durability does not
the nozzle. (GVWR), front and rear Gross Axle Weight Rating necessarily increase the vehicle's GVWR.
(GAWR), and Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).
5. Remove the fuel nozzle and close the fuel Tire Size
door. A Month-Day-Hour (MDH) number is included on
this label and indicates the Month, Day and Hour of The tire size on the Vehicle Certification Label
manufacture. The bar code that appears on the represents the actual tire size on your vehicle.
WARNING! bottom of the label is your VIN. Replacement tires must be equal to the load
capacity of this tire size.
Never have any smoking materials lit in or Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
near the vehicle when the fuel door is open or Rim Size
The GVWR is the total permissible weight of your
the tank is being filled.
vehicle including driver, passengers, vehicle, This is the rim size that is appropriate for the tire 4
Never add fuel when the engine is running. options and cargo. The label also specifies size listed.
This is in violation of most state and federal maximum capacities of front and rear Gross Axle Inflation Pressure
fire regulations and may cause the Malfunc- Weight Rating (GAWR). Total load must be limited so
This is the cold tire inflation pressure for your
tion Indicator Light to turn on. GVWR and front and rear GAWR are not exceeded.
vehicle for all loading conditions up to full GAWR.
A fire may result if fuel is pumped into a Payload Curb Weight
portable container that is inside of a vehicle. The payload of a vehicle is defined as the allowable
You could be burned. Always place fuel The curb weight of a vehicle is defined as the total
load weight a truck can carry, including the weight
containers on the ground while filling. weight of the vehicle with all fluids, including
of the driver, all passengers, options and cargo.
vehicle fuel, at full capacity conditions, and with no
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) occupants or cargo loaded into the vehicle. The
VEHICLE LOADING The GAWR is the maximum permissible load on the front and rear curb weight values are determined
front and rear axles. The load must be distributed by weighing your vehicle on a commercial scale
CERTIFICATION LABEL in the cargo area so that the GAWR of each axle is before any occupants or cargo are added.
As required by National Highway Traffic Safety not exceeded. Loading
Administration regulations, your vehicle has a Each axle GAWR is determined by the components The actual total weight and the weight of the front
certification label affixed to the driver's side door or in the system with the lowest load carrying capacity and rear of your vehicle at the ground can best be
pillar. (axle, springs, tires or wheels). Heavier axles or determined by weighing it when it is loaded and
ready for operation.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 154
Trailer Sway Control (TSC) These kinds of hitches are commonly used to tow recommended for heavier Tongue Weights (TW)
small and medium sized trailers. and may be required depending on vehicle and
The TSC can be a mechanical telescoping link that
trailer configuration/loading to comply with Gross
can be installed between the hitch receiver and the Weight-Distributing Hitch
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) requirements.
trailer tongue that typically provides adjustable A Weight-Distributing system works by applying
friction associated with the telescoping motion to leverage through spring (load) bars. They are WARNING!
dampen any unwanted trailer swaying motions typically used for heavier loads to distribute trailer
while traveling. tongue weight to the tow vehicle's front axle and An improperly adjusted Weight-Distributing
If equipped, the electronic TSC recognizes a the trailer axle(s). When used in accordance with Hitch system may reduce handling, stability,
swaying trailer and automatically applies individual the manufacturer's directions, it provides for a braking performance, and could result in a
wheel brakes and/or reduces engine power to more level ride, offering more consistent steering collision.
attempt to eliminate the trailer sway. and brake control thereby enhancing towing Weight-Distributing systems may not be
4
safety. The addition of a friction/hydraulic sway compatible with surge brake couplers. Consult
Weight-Carrying Hitch
control also dampens sway caused by traffic and with your hitch and trailer manufacturer or a
A weight-carrying hitch supports the trailer tongue crosswinds and contributes positively to tow reputable Recreational Vehicle dealer for
weight, just as if it were luggage located at a hitch vehicle and trailer stability. Trailer sway control and additional information.
ball or some other connecting point of the vehicle. a Weight-Distributing (load equalizing) Hitch are
TRAILER AND TONGUE W EIGHT NOTE: Perform the maintenance listed in Scheduled
Remember that everything put into or on the trailer Servicing and the proper maintenance intervals
Never exceed the maximum tongue weight adds to the load on your vehicle. Also, additional Ú page 267. When towing a trailer, never exceed
stamped on your trailer hitch. factory-installed options, or authorized the GAWR or GCWR ratings.
dealer-installed options, must be considered as
part of the total load on your vehicle. Refer to the WARNING!
tire loading information placard located on the Make certain that the load is secured in the
driver’s door pillar for the maximum combined trailer and will not shift during travel. When
weight of occupants and cargo for your vehicle. trailering cargo that is not fully secured,
TOWING REQUIREMENTS dynamic load shifts can occur that may be
difficult for the driver to control. You could lose
To promote proper break-in of your new vehicle control of your vehicle and have a collision.
drivetrain components, the following guidelines
are recommended. When hauling cargo or towing a trailer, do not
overload your vehicle or trailer. Overloading
Weight Distribution CAUTION! can cause a loss of control, poor performance
or damage to brakes, axle, engine, transmis-
Consider the following items when computing the Do not tow a trailer at all during the first sion, steering, suspension, chassis structure
weight on the front/rear axles of the vehicle: 500 miles (805 km) the new vehicle is driven. or tires.
The trailer tongue weight of the trailer. The engine, axle or other parts could be
damaged. Safety chains must always be used between
The weight of any other type of cargo or equip- your vehicle and trailer. Always connect the
ment put in or on your vehicle. Then, during the first 500 miles (805 km) that chains to the hook retainers of the vehicle
The weight of the driver and all passengers. a trailer is towed, do not drive over 50 mph hitch. Cross the chains under the trailer
(80 km/h) and do not make starts at full tongue and allow enough slack for turning
throttle. This helps the engine and other parts corners.
of the vehicle wear in at the heavier loads.
(Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 157
NOTE: RECREATIONAL TOWING — 3. Apply the Electric Park Brake (EPB). Place the
When towing your vehicle, always follow appli- transmission in PARK (P). Turn the engine off.
F RONT-WHEEL DRIVE (FWD) M ODELS
cable state and provincial laws. Contact state 4. Properly secure the front wheels to the dolly,
and provincial Highway Safety offices for addi- Recreational towing is allowed ONLY if the front following the dolly manufacturer's instructions.
tional details. wheels are OFF the ground. This may be
5. Turn the ignition to the ON/RUN position, but
accomplished using a tow dolly (front wheels off
You must ensure that the Auto Park Brake do not start the engine.
the ground) or vehicle trailer (all four wheels off the
feature is disabled before towing this vehicle, to 6. Press and hold the brake pedal.
ground). If using a tow dolly, follow this procedure:
avoid inadvertent Electric Park Brake engage-
ment. The Auto Park Brake feature is enabled or 1. Properly secure the dolly to the tow vehicle, 7. Release the EPB.
disabled via the Customer Programmable following the dolly manufacturer's 8. Turn the ignition OFF, remove the key fob, and
Features in the Uconnect Settings. instructions. release the brake pedal.
2. Drive the front wheels onto the tow dolly.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 161
Flowing Water Driving In Snow, Mud And Sand If you stall or begin to lose headway while climbing
If the water is swift flowing and rising (as in storm a steep hill, allow your vehicle to come to a stop
In heavy snow, when pulling a load, or for
run-off) avoid crossing until the water level recedes and immediately apply the brakes. Once stopped,
additional control at slower speeds, shift the
and/or the flow rate is reduced. If you must cross shift to REVERSE. Back slowly down the hill
transmission to a low gear and shift the 4WD
flowing-water, avoid depths in excess of 9 inches allowing the compression braking of the engine to
system to the appropriate terrain mode, using
(22 cm). The flowing water can erode the help regulate your speed. If the brakes are
4WD LOW if necessary Ú page 112. Do not shift to
streambed causing your vehicle to sink into deeper required to control vehicle speed, apply them
a lower gear than necessary to maintain headway.
water. Determine exit point(s) that are downstream lightly and avoid locking or skidding the tires.
Over-revving the engine can spin the wheels and
of your entry point to allow for drifting. traction will be lost.
WARNING!
Standing Water Avoid abrupt downshifts on icy or slippery roads
because engine braking may cause skidding and If the engine stalls or you lose headway or
Avoid driving in standing water deeper than
loss of control. cannot make it to the top of a steep hill or grade,
16 inches (40.5 cm), and reduce speed
never attempt to turn around. To do so may
appropriately to minimize wave effects. Maximum Hill Climbing result in tipping and rolling the vehicle. Always
speed in 16 inches (40.5 cm) of water is less than
NOTE: back straight down a hill in REVERSE gear
5 mph (8 km/h).
Before attempting to climb a hill, determine the carefully. Never back down a hill in NEUTRAL
(Trailhawk only): Avoid driving in standing water conditions at the crest and/or on the other side. using only the brake.
deeper than 19 inches (48 cm), and reduce speed
appropriately to minimize wave effects. Maximum Before climbing a steep hill, shift the transmission
speed in 19 inches (48 cm) of water is less than to a lower gear and shift the 4WD System to 4WD NOTE:
5 mph (8 km/h). LOW. Use FIRST gear and 4WD LOW for very steep Remember, never drive diagonally across a hill -
hills. drive straight up or down.
Maintenance
NOTE: If the wheels start to slip as you approach the crest
After driving through deep water, inspect your Brakes should be applied at increased slippage, of a hill, ease off the accelerator and maintain
vehicle fluids and lubricants (engine, transmission, but before coming to a stop to avoid digging into headway by turning the front wheels slowly left and
Power Transfer Unit, and Rear Drive Module) to the loose surface and rendering the operator of the right. This may provide a fresh “bite” into the
ensure they have not been contaminated. vehicle stuck/immobile. surface and may provide traction to complete the
Contaminated fluids and lubricants (milky, foamy climb.
in appearance) should be flushed/changed as
soon as possible to prevent component damage.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 163
Traction Downhill After Driving Off-Road After extended operation in mud, sand, water, or
similar dirty conditions, have the radiator, fan,
Shift the transmission into a low gear and the 4WD Off-road operation puts more stress on your
brake rotors, wheels, brake linings, and axle
System to 4WD LOW range or select Hill Descent vehicle than does most on-road driving. After going
yokes inspected and cleaned as soon as
Control (if equipped) Ú page 191. Let the vehicle off-road, it is always a good idea to check for
possible.
go slowly down the hill with all four wheels turning damage.
against engine compression drag. This will permit Completely inspect the underbody of your WARNING!
you to control the vehicle speed and direction. vehicle. Check tires, body structure, steering,
When descending mountains or hills, repeated suspension, and exhaust system for damage. Abrasive material in any part of the braking
braking can cause brake fade with loss of braking system may cause excessive wear or
Inspect the radiator for mud and debris and unpredictable braking performance. Full braking
control. Avoid repeated heavy braking by clean as required.
downshifting the transmission whenever possible. power may not be available to prevent a 4
Check threaded fasteners for looseness, partic- collision. If you have been operating your vehicle
ularly on the chassis, drivetrain components, in dirty conditions, inspect and clean the braking
steering, and suspension. Retighten them, if components as soon as possible.
required, and torque to the values specified in
the Service Manual.
Impacted material can cause wheel imbalance.
Check for accumulations of plants or brush. Freeing the wheels of impacted material will
These things could be a fire hazard. They might likely rectify imbalance condition.
hide damage to fuel lines, brake hoses, axle
pinion seals, and propeller shafts.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 164
164
MULTIMEDIA
UCONNECT SYSTEMS require software updates to improve the usability
and performance of your systems or to reduce the
NOTE:
FCA US LLC or your dealer may contact you
For detailed information about your potential risk of unauthorized and unlawful access directly regarding software updates.
Uconnect 5 With 8.4-inch Display system or to your vehicle systems.
Uconnect 5/5 NAV With 10.1-inch Display, refer to To help further improve vehicle security and
The risk of unauthorized and unlawful access to minimize the potential risk of a security breach,
your Uconnect Owner’s Manual Supplement. your vehicle systems may still exist, even if the vehicle owners should:
NOTE: most recent version of vehicle software (such as
Uconnect screen images are for illustration Routinely check www.driveuconnect.com
Uconnect software) is installed.
purposes only and may not reflect exact software (US Residents) or www.driveuconnect.ca
for your vehicle. WARNING! (Canadian Residents) to learn about avail-
able Uconnect software updates.
It is not possible to know or to predict all of the
CYBERSECURITY possible outcomes if your vehicle’s systems Only connect and use trusted media
are breached. It may be possible that vehicle devices (e.g. personal mobile phones or
Your vehicle may be a connected vehicle and may USBs).
be equipped with both wired and wireless systems, including safety related systems,
networks. These networks allow your vehicle to could be impaired or a loss of vehicle control Privacy of any wireless and wired communications
send and receive information. This information could occur that may result in an accident cannot be assured. Third parties may unlawfully
allows systems and features in your vehicle to involving serious injury or death. intercept information and private communications
function properly. without your consent Ú page 98.
ONLY insert trusted devices/components into
Your vehicle may be equipped with certain security your vehicle. Media of unknown origin could
features to reduce the risk of unauthorized and possibly contain malicious software, and if
unlawful access to vehicle systems and wireless installed in your vehicle, it may increase the
communications. Vehicle software technology possibility for vehicle systems to be breached.
continues to evolve over time and FCA US LLC,
As always, if you experience unusual vehicle
working with its suppliers, evaluates and takes
behavior, take your vehicle to your nearest
appropriate steps as needed. Similar to a
authorized dealer immediately.
computer or other devices, your vehicle may
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 165
MULTIMEDIA 165
UCONNECT SETTINGS CUSTOMER PROGRAMMABLE F EATURES For the Uconnect 5 With 8.4-inch Display and the
Uconnect 5/5 NAV With 10.1-inch Display
The Uconnect system uses a combination of Press the Vehicle button, then press the Settings
buttons on the touchscreen and buttons on the tab on the top of the touchscreen. In this menu, the
faceplate located in the center of the instrument Uconnect system allows you to access all of the
panel. These buttons allow you to access and available programmable features.
change Programmable Features. Many features
can vary by vehicle and packages. NOTE:
Buttons on the faceplate are located below and/or Only one touchscreen area may be selected at a
beside the Uconnect system in the center of the time.
instrument panel. In addition, there is a Scroll/ Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature
Enter control knob below and to the right of the settings may vary.
screen. Turn the control knob to scroll through When making a selection, press the button on the
menus and change settings. Push the center of the 5
touchscreen to enter the desired menu. Once in
control knob one or more times to select or change Uconnect 5 With 8.4-inch Display Buttons On Faceplate the desired menu, press and release the preferred
a setting. And Soft Buttons On Touchscreen setting option until a check mark appears next to
Your Uconnect system may also have Screen Off the setting, showing that setting has been
1 — Uconnect Buttons On The Touchscreen
and Mute buttons on the faceplate. selected. Once the setting is complete, press the
2 — Uconnect Buttons On The Faceplate Vehicle button to exit to the screen. Pressing the
Push the Screen Off button on the faceplate to turn
off the Uconnect screen. Push the button again or Up or Down Arrow button on the right side of the
tap the screen to turn the screen on. screen will allow you to toggle up or down through
the available settings.
Press the Back Arrow button to exit out of a Menu
or certain option on the Uconnect system.
Push and hold the Power button on the radio’s
faceplate for a minimum of 15 seconds to reset
the radio.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 166
166 MULTIMEDIA
My Profile
When the My Profile button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system displays options related to the vehicle’s profiles.
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
MULTIMEDIA 167
168 MULTIMEDIA
MULTIMEDIA 169
Display
When the Display button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system will display the options related to the theme (if equipped), brightness, and color of the
touchscreen. The available settings are:
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
170 MULTIMEDIA
Safety/Driving Assistance
When the Safety/Driving Assistance button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system displays the options related to the vehicle’s safety settings. These
options will differ depending on the features equipped on the vehicle. The settings may display in list form or within subfolders on the screen. To access a
subfolder, select the desired folder; the available options related to that feature will then display on the screen.
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
MULTIMEDIA 171
172 MULTIMEDIA
MULTIMEDIA 173
174 MULTIMEDIA
Phone/Bluetooth®
When the Phone/Bluetooth® button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system displays the options related to Bluetooth® connectivity from an external audio
device or smartphone. The list of paired audio devices or smartphones can be accessed from this menu.
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
Voice
When the Voice button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system displays the options related to the vehicle’s Voice Recognition feature.
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
MULTIMEDIA 175
Navigation
When the Navigation button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system displays options related to the vehicle’s built-in Navigation system. These settings can
change which icons display on the map, how “time to arrival is calculated”, and route types.
5
For more information on Navigation and settings, refer to the Uconnect Owner’s Manual Supplement.
Camera
When the Camera button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system displays the options related to the vehicle’s camera features.
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
176 MULTIMEDIA
MULTIMEDIA 177
Lights
When the Lights button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system displays the options related to the vehicle’s exterior and interior lights.
NOTE:
When the “Daytime Running Lights” feature is selected, the daytime running lights can be turned on or off. This feature is only allowed by law in the country of
the vehicle purchased.
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
178 MULTIMEDIA
Brakes
After pressing the Brakes button on the touchscreen, the following settings will be available:
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
MULTIMEDIA 179
180 MULTIMEDIA
MULTIMEDIA 181
Audio
When the Audio button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system displays options related to the vehicle’s sound system. These settings can change the audio
location within the vehicle, adjust the bass or treble levels, and auto-play settings from an audio device or smartphone.
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
182 MULTIMEDIA
MULTIMEDIA 183
Notifications
When the Notifications button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system displays the options related to Notifications for the system.
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
184 MULTIMEDIA
SiriusXM® Setup
NOTE:
A subscription to SiriusXM® satellite radio is required for these settings to be functional.
When the SiriusXM® Setup button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system displays the options related to SiriusXM® satellite radio. These settings can be
used to skip specific radio channels and restart favorite songs from the beginning.
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
Software Updates
When the Software Updates button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system will display the setting related to updating the Uconnect software.
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
MULTIMEDIA 185
System Information
When the System Information button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system displays the radio system information.
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
Reset
When the Reset button is pressed on the touchscreen, the system displays the options related to resetting the Uconnect system back to its default settings.
These settings can clear personal data and reset selected settings from other menus. 5
NOTE:
Depending on the vehicle’s options, feature settings may vary.
186 MULTIMEDIA
RADIO OPERATION AND MOBILE PHONES REGULATORY AND SAFETY The radio manufacturer believes the internal
wireless radio is safe for use by consumers.
Under certain conditions, the mobile phone being I NFORMATION The level of energy emitted is far less than the
on in your vehicle can cause erratic or noisy US/CANADA electromagnetic energy emitted by wireless
performance from your radio. This condition may devices such as mobile phones. However, the
be lessened or eliminated by repositioning the Exposure to Radio Frequency Radiation
use of wireless radios may be restricted in some
mobile phone within the vehicle. This condition is The radiated output power of the internal wireless situations or environments, such as aboard
not harmful to the radio. If your radio performance radio is far below the FCC and IC radio frequency airplanes. If you are unsure of restrictions, you are
does not satisfactorily improve from repositioning exposure limits. Nevertheless, the wireless radio encouraged to ask for authorization before turning
the mobile phone, it is recommended that the will be used in such a manner that the radio is on the wireless radio Ú page 328.
volume be turned down or off during mobile phone 8 inches (20 cm) or further from the human body.
operation when not using the Uconnect system. The internal wireless radio operates within
guidelines found in radio frequency safety
standards and recommendations, which reflect
the consensus of the scientific community.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 187
187
SAFETY
SAFETY FEATURES The ABS is designed to function with the Original
Equipment Manufacturer (OEM) tires. Modification WARNING!
ANTI-L OCK BRAKE S YSTEM (ABS) may result in degraded ABS performance. The ABS cannot prevent collisions, including
those resulting from excessive speed in turns,
The ABS provides increased vehicle stability and WARNING! following another vehicle too closely, or hydro-
brake performance under most braking conditions. planing.
The ABS contains sophisticated electronic
The system automatically prevents wheel lock and
equipment that may be susceptible to interfer- The capabilities of an ABS equipped vehicle
enhances vehicle control during braking.
ence caused by improperly installed or high must never be exploited in a reckless or
The ABS performs a self-check cycle to ensure that output radio transmitting equipment. This dangerous manner that could jeopardize the
the ABS is working properly each time the vehicle interference can cause possible loss of user’s safety or the safety of others.
is started and driven. During this self-check, you anti-lock braking capability. Installation of
may hear a slight clicking sound as well as some such equipment should be performed by
related motor noises. qualified professionals. Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Warning 6
The ABS is activated during braking when the Light
Pumping of the Anti-Lock Brakes will diminish
system detects one or more wheels are beginning their effectiveness and may lead to a collision. The yellow ABS Warning Light will turn on when the
to lock. Road conditions such as ice, snow, gravel, Pumping makes the stopping distance longer. ignition is placed in the ON/RUN mode and may
bumps, railroad tracks, loose debris, or panic stops Just press firmly on your brake pedal when you stay on for as long as four seconds.
may increase the likelihood of ABS activation(s). need to slow down or stop. If the ABS Warning Light remains on or comes on
You also may experience the following normal while driving, it indicates that the anti-lock portion
The ABS cannot prevent the natural laws of
characteristics when the ABS activates: of the brake system is not functioning and that
physics from acting on the vehicle, nor can it
ABS motor noise or clicking sounds (you may service is required. However, the conventional
increase braking or steering efficiency beyond
continue to hear for a short time after the stop) brake system will continue to operate normally if
that afforded by the condition of the vehicle
the ABS Warning Light is on.
Brake pedal pulsations brakes and tires or the traction afforded.
If the ABS Warning Light is on, the brake system
A slight drop of the brake pedal at the end of (Continued)
should be serviced as soon as possible to restore
the stop the benefits of Anti-lock Brakes. If the ABS Warning
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 188
188 SAFETY
Light does not come on when the ignition is placed To receive the benefit of the system, you must Dynamic Steering Torque (DST)
in the ON/RUN mode, have the light repaired as apply continuous braking pressure during the
DST is a feature of the Electronic Stability Control
soon as possible. stopping sequence (do not “pump” the brakes). Do
(ESC) and Electric Power Steering (EPS) modules
not reduce brake pedal pressure unless braking is
ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL (EBC) no longer desired. Once the brake pedal is
that provides torque at the steering wheel for
certain driving conditions in which the ESC module
SYSTEM released, the BAS is deactivated.
is detecting vehicle instability. The torque that the
Your vehicle is equipped with an advanced steering wheel receives is only meant to help the
WARNING!
Electronic Brake Control (EBC) system. This system driver realize optimal steering behavior in order to
includes Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS), Brake Assist The Brake Assist System (BAS) cannot prevent the reach/maintain vehicle stability. The only
System (BAS), Electronic Brake Force Distribution natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle, notification the driver receives that the feature is
(EBD), Electronic Roll Mitigation (ERM), Electronic nor can it increase the traction afforded by active is the torque applied to the steering wheel.
Stability Control (ESC), Hill Start Assist (HSA), and prevailing road conditions. BAS cannot prevent NOTE:
Traction Control System (TCS). These systems work collisions, including those resulting from excessive The DST feature is only meant to help the driver
together to enhance both vehicle stability and speed in turns, driving on very slippery surfaces, or realize the correct course of action through small
control in various driving conditions. hydroplaning. The capabilities of a BAS-equipped torques on the steering wheel, which means the
vehicle must never be exploited in a reckless or effectiveness of the DST feature is highly
Your vehicle may also be equipped with Dynamic
dangerous manner, which could jeopardize the dependent on the driver’s sensitivity and overall
Steering Torque (DST), Hill Descent Control (HDC),
user's safety or the safety of others. reaction to the applied torque. It is very important
Rain Brake Support (RBS), Ready Alert Braking
(RAB), and Trailer Sway Control (TSC). to realize that this feature will not steer the vehicle,
Brake System Warning Light meaning the driver is still responsible for steering
Brake Assist System (BAS) the vehicle.
The BAS is designed to optimize the vehicle’s The red Brake System Warning Light will turn on
when the ignition is placed in the ON/RUN mode Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD)
braking capability during emergency braking
maneuvers. The system detects an emergency and may stay on for as long as four seconds. EBD manages the distribution of the braking
braking situation by sensing the rate and amount If the Brake System Warning Light remains on or torque between the front and rear axles by limiting
of brake application and then applies optimum comes on while driving, it indicates that the brake braking pressure to the rear axle. This is done to
pressure to the brakes. This can help reduce system is not functioning properly and that prevent overslip of the rear wheels to avoid vehicle
braking distances. The BAS complements the immediate service is required. If the Brake System instability, and to prevent the rear axle from
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS). Applying the brakes Warning Light does not come on when the ignition entering ABS before the front axle.
very quickly results in the best BAS assistance. is placed in the ON/RUN mode, have the light
repaired as soon as possible.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 189
SAFETY 189
Electronic Roll Mitigation (ERM) Electronic Stability Control (ESC) The ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light
located in the instrument cluster will start to flash
ERM anticipates the potential for wheel lift by ESC enhances directional control and stability of
as soon as the ESC system becomes active. The
monitoring the driver’s steering wheel input and the vehicle under various driving conditions. ESC
ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light also
the speed of the vehicle. When ERM determines corrects for oversteering or understeering of the
flashes when the TCS is active. If the ESC
that the rate of change of the steering wheel angle vehicle by applying the brake of the appropriate
Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light begins to
and vehicle’s speed are sufficient to potentially wheel(s) to counteract the above conditions.
flash during acceleration, ease up on the
cause wheel lift, it then applies the appropriate Engine power may also be reduced to help the
accelerator and apply as little throttle as possible.
brake and may also reduce engine power to lessen vehicle maintain the desired path.
Be sure to adapt your speed and driving to the
the chance that wheel lift will occur. ERM can only Oversteer — when the vehicle is turning more prevailing road conditions.
reduce the chance of wheel lift occurring during than appropriate for the steering wheel position.
severe or evasive driving maneuvers; it cannot
Understeer — when the vehicle is turning less WARNING!
prevent wheel lift due to other factors, such as
road conditions, leaving the roadway, or striking than appropriate for the steering wheel position. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) cannot
objects or other vehicles. ESC uses sensors in the vehicle to determine the prevent the natural laws of physics from
vehicle path intended by the driver and compares acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase the
WARNING! it to the actual path of the vehicle. When the actual traction afforded by prevailing road condi- 6
path does not match the intended path, ESC tions. ESC cannot prevent accidents, including
Many factors, such as vehicle loading, road
applies the brake of the appropriate wheel to those resulting from excessive speed in turns,
conditions and driving conditions, influence
assist in counteracting the oversteer or understeer driving on very slippery surfaces, or hydro-
the chance that wheel lift or rollover may occur.
condition. planing. ESC also cannot prevent accidents
ERM cannot prevent all wheel lift or rollovers,
resulting from loss of vehicle control due to
especially those that involve leaving the roadway
inappropriate driver input for the conditions.
or striking objects or other vehicles. The
Only a safe, attentive, and skillful driver can
capabilities of an ERM-equipped vehicle must
prevent accidents. The capabilities of an ESC
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous
equipped vehicle must never be exploited in a
manner which could jeopardize the user's safety
reckless or dangerous manner which could
or the safety of others.
jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety of
others.
(Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 190
190 SAFETY
Partial Off
WARNING! WARNING!
This mode may be useful if the vehicle becomes
Vehicle modifications, or failure to properly stuck. This mode may modify TCS and ESC Trailer Sway Control (TSC) is disabled when
maintain your vehicle, may change the thresholds for activation, which allows for more the ESC system is in the “Partial Off” mode.
handling characteristics of your vehicle, and wheel spin than normally allowed.
may negatively affect the performance of the Full Off (Four-Wheel Drive Models Only)
To enter the “Partial Off” mode, momentarily push
ESC system. Changes to the steering system,
the ESC OFF button, located below the radio. The This mode is intended for off-highway or off-road
suspension, braking system, tire type and size
ESC OFF Indicator Light will illuminate. To turn the use when ESC stability features could inhibit
or wheel size may adversely affect ESC perfor-
ESC on again, momentarily push the ESC OFF vehicle maneuverability due to trail conditions.
mance. Improperly inflated and unevenly worn
button and the ESC OFF Indicator Light will turn off. This mode is entered by pushing and holding the
tires may also degrade ESC performance. Any
vehicle modification or poor vehicle mainte- NOTE: ESC OFF button for five seconds when the vehicle
nance that reduces the effectiveness of the When driving with snow chains, or when starting off is stopped and the engine is running. After five
ESC system can increase the risk of loss of in deep snow, sand, or gravel, it may be desirable to seconds, the ESC OFF Indicator Light will illuminate
vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal allow more wheel spin. This can be accomplished by and the “ESC OFF” message will appear in the
injury and death. momentarily pushing the ESC OFF button to enter instrument cluster display.
“Partial Off” mode. Once the situation requiring In this mode, ESC and TCS, except for the “limited
“Partial Off” mode is overcome, turn ESC back on by slip” feature described in the TCS section, are
ESC Operating Modes momentarily pushing the ESC OFF button. This may turned off until the vehicle reaches a speed of
Depending upon model and mode of operation, the be done while the vehicle is in motion. 40 mph (64 km/h). At 40 mph (64 km/h), the
ESC system may have multiple operating modes. system returns to “Partial Off” mode, as described
ESC On WARNING! above. TCS remains off. When the vehicle speed
When in “Partial Off” mode, the TCS function- drops below 30 mph (48 km/h), the ESC system
This is the normal operating mode for the ESC.
ality of ESC, except for the limited slip feature shuts off. ESC is deactivated at low vehicle speeds
Whenever the vehicle is started, the ESC system
described in the TCS section, has been so that it will not interfere with off-road driving.
will be in this mode. This mode should be used for
disabled and the ESC OFF Indicator Light will However, ESC function returns to provide the
most driving conditions. Alternate ESC modes
be illuminated. When in “Partial Off” mode, stability feature at speeds above 40 mph
should only be used for specific reasons as noted
the engine power reduction feature of TCS is (64 km/h). The ESC OFF Indicator Light will always
in the following paragraphs.
disabled, and the enhanced vehicle stability be illuminated when ESC is off.
offered by the ESC system is reduced.
(Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 191
SAFETY 191
To turn ESC on again, momentarily push the ESC driven several miles (km) at speeds greater than The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking
OFF button. This will restore the “ESC On” mode of 30 mph (48 km/h), see an authorized dealer as sounds when it is active. This is normal; the
operation. soon as possible to have the problem diagnosed sounds will stop when ESC becomes inactive
NOTE: and corrected. following the maneuver that caused the ESC
The “ESC OFF” message will display and an audible The ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light activation.
chime will sound when the gear selector is placed starts to flash as soon as the tires lose traction and Emergency Stop Signal (ESS) —
into the PARK position from any other position, and the ESC system becomes active. The ESC If Equipped
then moved out of the PARK position. This will Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light also flashes
occur even if the message was previously cleared. when Traction Control System (TCS) is active. If the The ESS activates the hazard lights at a faster than
ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light begins normal speed when heavy brake pressure is
WARNING! to flash during acceleration, ease up on the applied. ESS will only activate when the speed is
accelerator and apply as little throttle as possible. above 31 mph (50 km/h). The ESS operates
In the "Full Off" mode, the engine torque independently of other lamps, and will turn on and
reduction and stability features are disabled. In Be sure to adapt your speed and driving to the
prevailing road conditions. off automatically. This indicates to others that the
an emergency evasive maneuver, the ESC vehicle is stopping quickly.
system will not engage to assist in maintaining The ESC OFF Indicator Light indicates the
stability. “Full Off” mode is intended for customer has elected to have the NOTE: 6
off-highway or off-road use only. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) in a A warning light will illuminate within the instru-
reduced mode. ment cluster to inform the driver that the ESS
feature has been activated.
ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light NOTE:
The ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light When towing a trailer, ESS will also activate the
And ESC OFF Indicator Light rear indicator lights of the trailer.
and the ESC OFF Indicator Light come on
The ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
Light in the instrument cluster will come
momentarily each time the ignition is placed in Hill Descent Control (HDC) — If Equipped
the ON/RUN position. Hill Descent Control (HDC) is intended for low
on when the ignition is placed in the ON
mode. It should go out with the engine Each time the ignition is placed in the ON/RUN speed off-road driving while in 4WD Low. HDC
running. If the ESC Activation/Malfunction position, the ESC system will be on even if it was maintains vehicle speed while descending hills
Indicator Light comes on continuously with the turned off previously. during various driving situations. HDC controls
engine running, a malfunction has been detected vehicle speed by actively controlling the brakes.
in the ESC system. If this light remains on after
several ignition cycles, and the vehicle has been
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 192
192 SAFETY
SAFETY 193
194 SAFETY
Ready Alert Braking (RAB) Trailer Sway Control (TSC) AUXILIARY DRIVING SYSTEMS
RAB may reduce the time required to reach full TSC uses sensors in the vehicle to recognize an
braking during emergency braking situations. It excessively swaying trailer and will take the BLIND SPOT MONITORING (BSM) —
anticipates when an emergency braking situation appropriate actions to attempt to stop the sway. I F E QUIPPED
may occur by monitoring how fast the throttle is TSC will become active automatically once an
released by the driver. The Electronic Brake excessively swaying trailer is recognized. The BSM system uses two radar sensors, located
Controller (EBC) system will prepare the brake inside the rear fascia/bumper, to detect highway
NOTE:
system for a panic stop. licensable vehicles (automobiles, trucks,
TSC cannot stop all trailers from swaying. Always
motorcycles, etc.) that enter the blind spot zones
Traction Control System (TCS) use caution when towing a trailer and follow the
from the rear/front/side of the vehicle.
The TCS monitors the amount of wheel spin for trailer tongue weight recommendations
each of the driven wheels. If wheel spin is Ú page 154.
detected, the TCS may apply brake pressure to the When TSC is functioning, the ESC Activation/
spinning wheel(s) and/or reduce vehicle power to Malfunction Indicator Light will flash, the engine
provide enhanced acceleration and stability. A power may be reduced and you may feel the
feature of the TCS, Brake Limited Differential (BLD) brakes being applied to individual wheels to
functions similarly to a limited slip differential and attempt to stop the trailer from swaying. TSC is
controls the wheel spin across a driven axle. If one disabled when the ESC system is in the “Partial
wheel on a driven axle is spinning faster than the Off” or “Full Off” modes.
other, the system will apply the brake of the
spinning wheel. This will allow more vehicle torque WARNING!
to be applied to the wheel that is not spinning. If TSC activates while driving, slow the vehicle Rear Detection Zones
BLD may remain enabled even if TCS and ESC are down, stop at the nearest safe location, and
in reduced modes. When the vehicle is started, the BSM Warning Light
adjust the trailer load to eliminate trailer sway.
will momentarily illuminate in both outside
rearview mirrors to let the driver know that the
system is operational. The BSM system sensors
operate when the vehicle is in any forward gear
and enters standby mode when the vehicle is
in PARK.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 195
SAFETY 195
The BSM detection zone covers approximately if the vehicle is operated in areas with extremely that side of the vehicle, an audible chime will also
one lane width, 12 ft (3.8 m), on both sides of the low radar returns such as a desert or parallel to a be sounded when chimes are enabled. In addition
vehicle. The zone length starts at the outside large elevation drop. If blockage is detected, a to the audible alert the radio (if on) will also be
mirror and extends approximately 10 ft (3 m) “Blind Spot Temporarily Unavailable, Sensor muted during the chime event Ú page 198.
beyond the rear fascia/bumper of the vehicle. The Blocked” message will display in the cluster, both
BSM system monitors the detection zones on both mirror lights will illuminate, and BSM and RCP
sides of the vehicle when the vehicle speed alerts will not occur. This is normal operation. The
reaches approximately 6 mph (10 km/h) or higher system will automatically recover and resume
and will alert the driver of vehicles in these areas. function when the condition clears or when an
NOTE: ignition cycle occurs. To minimize system
blockage, do not block the area of the rear fascia/
The BSM system DOES NOT alert the driver
bumper where the radar sensors are located with
about rapidly approaching vehicles that are foreign objects (bumper stickers, bicycle racks,
outside the detection zones. etc.) and keep it clear of road contaminations.
The BSM system will automatically disable when
a trailer is detected. If the attached trailer is not Warning Light Location
detected, the system detection zone DOES NOT 6
change. Therefore, visually verify the adjacent As part of the Active Lane Management system, if
lane is clear for both your vehicle and trailer the vehicle begins to drift into an adjacent lane
before making a lane change. If the trailer or that has an active LED indication, the LED will flash
other object (i.e., bicycle, sports equipment) if steering torque is provided to guide the vehicle
extends beyond the side of your vehicle, this back to the center of the lane Ú page 145.
may result in the BSM warning light remaining The BSM system monitors the detection zone from
illuminated the entire time the vehicle is in a three different entry points (side, rear, front) while
forward gear. It may be necessary to deactivate driving to see if an alert is necessary. The BSM
the BSM system manually to avoid misdetection Radar Sensor Location (Driver Side Shown) system will issue an alert during these types of
Ú page 165. zone entries.
The BSM system will provide a visual alert in the
The BSM system can become blocked if snow, ice,
appropriate side view mirror based on a detected
mud, or other road contaminations accumulate on
object when enabled. If the turn signal is then
the rear fascia/bumper where the radar sensors
activated, and it corresponds to an alert present on
are located. The system may also detect blockage
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 196
196 SAFETY
Overtaking/Approaching
Side Monitoring
Rear Monitoring
Overtaking Traffic
If you pass another vehicle slowly with a relative
speed less than 10 mph (16 km/h), the warning
light will be illuminated. If the difference in speed
between the two vehicles is greater than 10 mph
(16 km/h), the warning light may not illuminate. Overtaking/Passing
The BSM system is designed not to issue an alert
on stationary objects such as guardrails, posts,
walls, foliage, berms, etc. However, occasionally
the system may alert on such objects. This is
normal operation and your vehicle does not require
service.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 197
SAFETY 197
The BSM system will not alert you of objects that Rear Cross Path (RCP) When RCP is on and the vehicle is in REVERSE (R),
are traveling in the opposite direction of the vehicle the driver is alerted using both the visual and
RCP is intended to aid the driver when backing out
in adjacent lanes Ú page 328. audible alarms, including reducing the radio
of parking spaces where their vision of oncoming
volume anytime the system is enabled regardless
vehicles may be blocked. Proceed slowly and
of the chime setting.
cautiously out of the parking space until the rear
end of the vehicle is exposed. The RCP system will NOTE:
then have a clear view of the cross traffic and if an In a parking lot situation, oncoming vehicles can be
oncoming vehicle is detected, alert the driver. blocked by vehicles parked on either side. If the
sensors are blocked by other structures or
vehicles, the system will not be able to alert the
driver.
WARNING!
Rear Cross Path Detection (RCP) is not a backup
Opposing Traffic
aid system. It is intended to be used to help a
driver detect an oncoming vehicle in a parking 6
WARNING! lot situation. Drivers must be careful when
The Blind Spot Monitoring system is only an aid backing up, even when using RCP. Always check
to help detect objects in the blind spot zones. carefully behind your vehicle, look behind you,
The BSM system is not designed to detect RCP Detection Zones and be sure to check for pedestrians, animals,
pedestrians, bicyclists, or animals. Even if your other vehicles, obstructions, and blind spots
RCP monitors the rear detection zones on both
vehicle is equipped with the BSM system, always before backing up. Failure to do so can result in
sides of the vehicle, for objects that are moving
check your vehicle’s mirrors, glance over your serious injury or death.
toward the side of the vehicle with a minimum
shoulder, and use your turn signal before speed of approximately 3 mph (5 km/h), to objects
changing lanes. Failure to do so can result in moving a maximum of approximately 20 mph
serious injury or death. (32 km/h), such as in parking lot situations.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 198
198 SAFETY
Blind Spot Modes When the system is in RCP, the system shall FORWARD C OLLISION WARNING (FCW)
respond with both visual and audible alerts when a
Blind Spot Alert has three selectable modes of
detected object is present. Whenever an audible WITH MITIGATION — I F EQUIPPED
operation that are available in the Uconnect
alert is requested, the radio volume is reduced. FCW with Mitigation provides the driver with
system.
Turn/hazard signal status is ignored; the RCP state audible warnings, visual warnings (within the
Blind Spot Alert Lights Only (Default Setting) always requests the chime. instrument cluster display), and may apply a brake
When operating in Lights Only mode, the BSM Blind Spot Alert Off jerk to warn the driver when it detects a potential
system will provide a visual alert in the appropriate frontal collision. The warnings and limited braking
When the BSM system is turned off, there will be
side view mirror based on a detected object. are intended to provide the driver with enough time
no visual or audible alerts from either the BSM or
However, when the system is operating in Rear to react, avoid or mitigate the potential collision.
RCP systems.
Cross Path (RCP) mode, the system will respond
NOTE:
with both visual and audible alerts when a NOTE:
FCW monitors the information from the forward
detected object is present. Whenever an audible The BSM system will store the current operating
looking sensors as well as the Electronic Brake
alert is requested, the radio is muted for the mode when the vehicle is shut off. Each time the
Controller (EBC), to calculate the probability of a
duration of the chime. vehicle is started the previously stored mode will
forward collision. When the system determines
Blind Spot Alert Lights/Chime be recalled and used.
that a forward collision is probable, the driver will
Blocked Sensor be provided with audible and visual warnings and
When operating in Blind Spot Alert Lights/Chime
mode, the BSM system will provide a visual alert in If the system detects degraded performance due may provide a brake jerk warning.
the appropriate side view mirror based on a to contamination or foreign objects, a message will If the driver does not take action based upon these
detected object. If the turn signal is then activated, warn you of a blocked sensor and the warning progressive warnings, then the system will provide
and it corresponds to an alert present on that side indicators in side view mirrors will be illuminated. a limited level of active braking to help slow the
of the vehicle, an audible chime will also be The warning indicators will remain illuminated until vehicle and mitigate the potential forward collision.
sounded. Whenever a turn signal and detected blockage clearing conditions are met. First clear If the driver reacts to the warnings by braking and
object are present on the same side at the same the fascia/bumper area around the sensors of the the system determines that the driver intends to
time, both the visual and audible alerts will be blockage. After removing the blockage, reset the avoid the collision by braking but has not applied
issued. In addition to the audible alert the radio system by cycling the ignition from ON to OFF and sufficient brake force, the system will compensate
(if on) will also be muted. then back ON. and provide additional brake force as required.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 199
SAFETY 199
200 SAFETY
SAFETY 201
202 SAFETY
be on. In this situation, the Tire Pressure The TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire
Monitoring System Warning Light will turn off only CAUTION! maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility
after the tires are inflated to the vehicle’s Using aftermarket tire sealants may cause the to maintain correct tire pressure using an accu-
recommended cold placard pressure value Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) rate tire pressure gauge, even if underinflation
Ú page 328. sensor to become inoperable. After using an has not reached the level to trigger illumination
NOTE: aftermarket tire sealant it is recommended of the Tire Pressure Monitoring System Warning
When filling warm tires, the tire pressure may need that you take your vehicle to an authorized Light.
to be increased up to an additional 4 psi (28 kPa) dealer to have your sensor function checked. Seasonal temperature changes will affect tire
above the recommended cold placard pressure in After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure pressure, and the TPMS will monitor the actual
order to turn the Tire Pressure Monitoring System always reinstall the valve stem cap. This will tire pressure in the tire.
Warning Light off. prevent moisture and dirt from entering the Premium System
valve stem, which could damage the TPMS
CAUTION! The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) uses
sensor.
wireless technology with wheel rim mounted
The TPMS has been optimized for the original electronic sensors to monitor tire pressure levels.
equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures NOTE: Sensors, mounted to each wheel as part of the
and warning have been established for the tire valve stem, transmit tire pressure readings to the
The TPMS is not intended to replace normal tire
size equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable receiver module.
care and maintenance, or to provide warning of
system operation or sensor damage may
a tire failure or condition. NOTE:
result when using replacement equipment
that is not of the same size, type, and/or style. The TPMS should not be used as a tire pressure It is particularly important for you to check the tire
The TPMS sensor is not designed for use on gauge while adjusting your tire pressure. pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle monthly
aftermarket wheels and may contribute to a and to maintain the proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly underinflated tire
poor overall system performance or sensor causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire The TPMS consists of the following components:
damage. Customers are encouraged to use failure. Underinflation also reduces fuel effi- Receiver module
OEM wheels to ensure proper TPMS feature ciency and tire tread life, and may affect the
Four Tire Pressure Monitoring System sensors
operation. vehicle’s handling and stopping ability.
Various Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(Continued)
messages, which will display in the instrument
cluster display
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Warning Light
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 203
SAFETY 203
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Low system will automatically update, the pressure display in place of the dashes. A system fault can
Pressure Warnings values in the graphic display in the instrument occur due to any of the following:
cluster will stop being highlighted or return to their Jamming due to electronic devices or driving
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System original color, and the Tire Pressure Monitoring
Warning Light will illuminate in the next to facilities emitting the same radio
System Warning Light will turn off. frequencies as the TPMS sensors
instrument cluster and a chime will sound
when tire pressure is low in one or more of NOTE: Installing some form of aftermarket window
the four active road tires. In addition, the instrument When filling warm tires, the tire pressure may need tinting that affects radio wave signals
cluster will display a "Tire Low" message, an “Inflate to be increased up to an additional 4 psi (28 kPa)
Lots of snow or ice around the wheels or wheel
to XX” message, and a graphic showing the above the recommended cold placard pressure in
order to turn the Tire Pressure Monitoring System housings
pressure values of each tire with the low tire
pressure values highlighted or in a different color. Warning Light off. Using tire chains on the vehicle
The vehicle may need to be driven for up to Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPMS
20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) in order for sensors
the TPMS to receive this information. Vehicles With Compact Spare Or Non-Matching
Service TPMS Warning Full Size Spare
6
When a system fault is detected, the Tire Pressure 1. The compact spare tire or non-matching full
Monitoring System Warning Light will flash on and size does not have a Tire Pressure Monitoring
off for 75 seconds and then remain on solid. The System sensor. Therefore, the TPMS will not
system fault will also sound a chime. In addition, the monitor the pressure in the compact or
instrument cluster will display a "SERVICE TPM non-matching full size spare tire.
SYSTEM" message for a minimum of five seconds 2. If you install the compact or non-matching full
and then display dashes (--) in place of the pressure size spare tire in place of a road tire that has a
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Low Pressure Warning
value to indicate which sensor is not being received. pressure below the low-pressure warning limit,
Should this occur, you should stop as soon as If the ignition key is cycled, this sequence will upon the next ignition key cycle, the Tire
possible and inflate the tires with low pressure repeat, providing the system fault still exists. If the Pressure Monitoring System Warning Light will
(those highlighted or in a different color in the system fault no longer exists, the Tire Pressure remain on and a chime will sound. In addition,
instrument cluster display graphic) to the vehicle’s Monitoring System Warning Light will no longer the graphic in the instrument cluster will still
recommended cold placard pressure value, as flash, and the “SERVICE TPM SYSTEM” message display a different color or highlighted pressure
shown in the “Inflate to XX” message. Once the will no longer display, and a pressure value will value and the “Inflate to XX” message.
system receives the updated tire pressures, the
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 204
204 SAFETY
3. After driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes TPMS Deactivation — If Equipped and then turn off. The instrument cluster will
above 15 mph (24 km/h), the Tire Pressure display the “SERVICE TPM SYSTEM” message and
The TPMS can be deactivated if replacing all four
Monitoring System Warning Light will flash on then display pressure values in place of the
wheel and tire assemblies (road tires) with wheel
and off for 75 seconds and then remain on dashes. On the next ignition cycle the "SERVICE
and tire assemblies that do not have TPMS
solid. In addition, the instrument cluster will TPM SYSTEM" message will no longer be displayed
sensors, such as when installing winter wheel and
display a “SERVICE TPM SYSTEM” message for as long as no system fault exists.
tire assemblies on your vehicle.
five seconds and then display dashes (--) in
place of the pressure value. To deactivate the TPMS, first replace all four wheel
and tire assemblies (road tires) with tires not
OCCUPANT RESTRAINT SYSTEMS
4. For each subsequent ignition key cycle, a Some of the most important safety features in your
equipped with Tire Pressure Monitoring System
chime will sound, the Tire Pressure Monitoring vehicle are the restraint systems:
(TPMS) sensors. Then, drive the vehicle for
System Warning Light will flash on and off for
20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h). The TPMS
75 seconds and then remain on solid, and the
will chime, the Tire Pressure Monitoring System
OCCUPANT R ESTRAINT S YSTEMS
instrument cluster will display a “SERVICE TPM FEATURES
Warning Light will flash on and off for 75 seconds
SYSTEM” message for five seconds and then
and then remain on. The instrument cluster will
display dashes (--) in place of the pressure Seat Belt Systems
display the “SERVICE TPM SYSTEM” message and
value. Supplemental Restraint Systems (SRS) Air Bags
then display dashes (--) in place of the pressure
5. Once you repair or replace the original road tire values. Child Restraints
and reinstall it on the vehicle in place of the
Beginning with the next ignition cycle, the TPMS Some of the safety features described in this
compact spare or non-matching full size, the
will no longer chime or display the “SERVICE TPM section may be standard equipment on some
TPMS will update automatically. In addition,
SYSTEM” message in the instrument cluster but models, or may be optional equipment on others.
the Tire Pressure Monitoring System Warning
dashes (--) will remain in place of the pressure If you are not sure, ask an authorized dealer.
Light will turn off and the graphic in the
values.
instrument cluster will display a new pressure
To reactivate the TPMS, replace all four wheel and
I MPORTANT SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
value instead of dashes (--), as long as no tire
pressure is below the low-pressure warning tire assemblies (road tires) with tires equipped with Please pay close attention to the information in
limit in any of the four active road tires. TPMS sensors. Then, drive the vehicle for up to this section. It tells you how to use your restraint
The vehicle may need to be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h). The TPMS system properly, to keep you and your passengers
20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) in order will chime, the Tire Pressure Monitoring System as safe as possible.
for the TPMS to receive this information. Warning Light will flash on and off for 75 seconds
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 205
SAFETY 205
Here are some simple steps you can take to 8. Do not lean against the door or window. If your Research has shown that seat belts save lives, and
minimize the risk of harm from a deploying air bag: vehicle has side air bags, and deployment they can reduce the seriousness of injuries in a
1. Children 12 years old and under should occurs, the side air bags will inflate forcefully collision. Some of the worst injuries happen when
always ride buckled up in the rear seat of a into the space between occupants and the people are thrown from the vehicle. Seat belts
vehicle with a rear seat. door and occupants could be injured. reduce the possibility of ejection and the risk of
9. If the air bag system in this vehicle needs to be injury caused by striking the inside of the vehicle.
2. A child who is not big enough to wear the Everyone in a motor vehicle should be belted at all
vehicle seat belt properly must be secured in modified to accommodate a disabled person,
see Ú page 325 for customer service contact times.
the appropriate child restraint or
belt-positioning booster seat in a rear seating information. Enhanced Seat Belt Use Reminder System
position Ú page 228. (BeltAlert)
3. If a child from 2 to 12 years old (not in a WARNING! Driver And Passenger BeltAlert — If Equipped
rear-facing child restraint) must ride in the Never place a rear-facing child restraint in BeltAlert is a feature intended to remind
front passenger seat, move the seat as far front of an air bag. A deploying passenger the driver and outboard front seat
back as possible and use the proper child front air bag can cause death or serious injury passenger (if equipped with outboard
restraint Ú page 228. to a child 12 years or younger, including a front passenger seat BeltAlert) to buckle 6
4. Never allow children to slide the shoulder belt child in a rear-facing child restraint. their seat belts. The BeltAlert feature is active
behind them or under their arm. whenever the ignition switch is in the START or
Never install a rear-facing child restraint in the
5. You should read the instructions provided with ON/RUN position.
front seat of a vehicle. Only use a rear-facing
your child restraint to make sure that you are child restraint in the rear seat. If the vehicle Initial Indication
using it properly. does not have a rear seat, do not transport a If the driver is unbuckled when the ignition switch
6. All occupants should always wear their lap and rear-facing child restraint in that vehicle. is first in the START or ON/RUN position, a chime
shoulder belts properly. will signal for a few seconds. If the driver or
outboard front seat passenger (if equipped with
7. The driver and front passenger seats should SEAT BELT S YSTEMS outboard front passenger seat BeltAlert) is
be moved back as far as practical to allow the
front air bags room to inflate. Buckle up even though you are an excellent driver, unbuckled when the ignition switch is first in the
even on short trips. Someone on the road may be START or ON/RUN position the Seat Belt Reminder
a poor driver and could cause a collision that Light will turn on and remain on until both outboard
includes you. This can happen far away from home front seat belts are buckled. The outboard front
or on your own street.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 206
206 SAFETY
passenger seat BeltAlert is not active when an front passenger seat or when the seat is folded flat
outboard front passenger seat is unoccupied. (if equipped). It is recommended that pets be WARNING!
BeltAlert Warning Sequence restrained in the rear seat (if equipped) in pet Relying on the air bags alone could lead to
harnesses or pet carriers that are secured by seat more severe injuries in a collision. The air
The BeltAlert warning sequence is activated when belts, and cargo is properly stowed. bags work with your seat belt to restrain you
the vehicle is moving above a specified vehicle
BeltAlert can be activated or deactivated by an properly. In some collisions, the air bags won’t
speed range and the driver or outboard front seat
authorized dealer. FCA US LLC does not deploy at all. Always wear your seat belt even
passenger is unbuckled (if equipped with outboard
recommend deactivating BeltAlert. though you have air bags.
front passenger seat BeltAlert) (the outboard front
passenger seat BeltAlert is not active when the NOTE: In a collision, you and your passengers can
outboard front passenger seat is unoccupied). The If BeltAlert has been deactivated and the driver or suffer much greater injuries if you are not
BeltAlert warning sequence starts by blinking the outboard front seat passenger (if equipped with properly buckled up. You can strike the inte-
Seat Belt Reminder Light and sounding an outboard front passenger seat BeltAlert) is rior of your vehicle or other passengers, or you
intermittent chime. Once the BeltAlert warning unbuckled the Seat Belt Reminder Light will turn can be thrown out of the vehicle. Always be
sequence has completed, the Seat Belt Reminder on and remain on until the driver and outboard sure you and others in your vehicle are
Light will remain on until the seat belts are front seat passenger seat belts are buckled. buckled up properly.
buckled. The BeltAlert warning sequence may Lap/Shoulder Belts It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside
repeat based on vehicle speed until the driver and
All seating positions in your vehicle are equipped or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people
occupied outboard front seat passenger seat belts
with lap/shoulder belts. riding in these areas are more likely to be seri-
are buckled. The driver should instruct all
ously injured or killed.
occupants to buckle their seat belts. The seat belt webbing retractor will lock only during
very sudden stops or collisions. This feature allows Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
Change Of Status
the shoulder part of the seat belt to move freely vehicle that is not equipped with seats and
If the driver or outboard front seat passenger with you under normal conditions. However, in a seat belts.
(if equipped with outboard front passenger seat collision the seat belt will lock and reduce your risk
BeltAlert) unbuckles their seat belt while the Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat
of striking the inside of the vehicle or being thrown and using a seat belt properly. Occupants,
vehicle is traveling, the BeltAlert warning sequence out of the vehicle.
will begin until the seat belts are buckled again. including the driver, should always wear their
seat belts whether or not an air bag is also
The outboard front passenger seat BeltAlert is not
provided at their seating position to minimize
active when the outboard front passenger seat is
the risk of severe injury or death in the event
unoccupied. BeltAlert may be triggered when an
of a crash.
animal or other items are placed on the outboard
(Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 207
SAFETY 207
208 SAFETY
4. Position the lap belt so that it is snug and lies Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure
low across your hips, below your abdomen. To
Use the following procedure to untwist a twisted
remove slack in the lap belt portion, pull up on
lap/shoulder belt.
the shoulder belt. To loosen the lap belt if it is
too tight, tilt the latch plate and pull on the lap 1. Position the latch plate as close as possible to
belt. A snug seat belt reduces the risk of sliding the anchor point.
under the seat belt in a collision. 2. At about 6 to 12 inches (15 to 30 cm) above
the latch plate, grab and twist the seat belt
webbing 180 degrees to create a fold that
begins immediately above the latch plate.
Pulling Out The Latch Plate 3. Slide the latch plate upward over the folded
webbing. The folded webbing must enter the
3. When the seat belt is long enough to fit, insert slot at the top of the latch plate.
the latch plate into the buckle until you hear
a “click”. 4. Continue to slide the latch plate up until it
clears the folded webbing and the seat belt is
no longer twisted.
SAFETY 209
NOTE:
The adjustable upper shoulder belt anchorage is
equipped with an Easy Up feature. This feature
allows the shoulder belt anchorage to be adjusted
in the upward position without pushing or Pulling Out The Latch Plate
squeezing the release button. To verify the
shoulder belt anchorage is latched, pull downward
on the shoulder belt anchorage until it is locked
into position.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 210
210 SAFETY
2. When the seat belt is long enough to fit, insert 5. Position the lap belt so that it is snug and lies
the mini-latch plate into the mini-buckle until low across your hips, below your abdomen. To
you hear a “click.” remove slack in the lap belt portion, pull up on
the shoulder belt. To loosen the lap belt if it is
too tight, pull on the lap belt. A snug seat belt
reduces the risk of sliding under the seat belt
in a collision.
6. Position the shoulder belt on your chest so that
it is comfortable and not resting on your neck.
The retractor will withdraw any slack in the
Inserting Latch Plate Into Buckle seat belt.
7. To release the seat belt, push the red button
on the buckle.
Inserting Mini-Latch Plate Into Mini-Buckle 8. To disengage the mini-latch plate from the
mini-buckle, insert the regular latch plate into
3. Sit back in seat. Slide the regular latch plate up the center red slot on the mini-buckle.
the webbing as far as necessary to allow the
seat belt to go around your lap.
4. When the seat belt is long enough to fit, insert
the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a
“click.”
Inserting Latch Plate Into Buckle
SAFETY 211
212 SAFETY
SAFETY 213
Your vehicle may be equipped with the following Air The ORC contains a backup power supply system
WARNING! Bag System Components: that may deploy the air bag system even if the
The seat belt assembly must be replaced if the battery loses power or it becomes disconnected
Air Bag System Components
switchable Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) prior to deployment.
feature or any other seat belt function is not Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
The ORC turns on the Air Bag Warning Light in the
working properly when checked according to Air Bag Warning Light instrument panel for approximately four to eight
the procedures in the Service Manual. seconds for a self-check when the ignition switch is
Steering Wheel and Column
Failure to replace the seat belt assembly first in the ON/RUN position. After the self-check,
Instrument Panel
could increase the risk of injury in collisions. the Air Bag Warning Light will turn off. If the ORC
Knee Impact Bolsters detects a malfunction in any part of the system, it
Do not use the Automatic Locking Mode to turns on the Air Bag Warning Light, either
Driver and Front Passenger Air Bags
restrain occupants who are wearing the seat momentarily or continuously. A single chime will
belt or children who are using booster seats. Seat Belt Buckle Switch
sound to alert you if the light comes on again after
The locked mode is only used to install Supplemental Side Air Bags initial startup.
rear-facing or forward-facing child restraints
Supplemental Knee Air Bags The ORC also includes diagnostics that will
that have a harness for restraining the child.
Front and Side Impact Sensors illuminate the instrument panel Air Bag Warning 6
Light if a malfunction is detected that could affect
Seat Belt Pretensioners
SUPPLEMENTAL R ESTRAINT S YSTEMS the air bag system. The diagnostics also record the
Seat Track Position Sensors nature of the malfunction. While the air bag system
(SRS) is designed to be maintenance free, if any of the
Occupant Classification System
Some of the safety features described in this following occurs, have an authorized dealer
section may be standard equipment on some
Air Bag Warning Light service the air bag system immediately.
models, or may be optional equipment on others. The Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
The Air Bag Warning Light does not come on
If you are not sure, ask an authorized dealer. monitors the readiness of the electronic
during the four to eight seconds when the igni-
parts of the air bag system whenever the
The air bag system must be ready to protect you in tion switch is first in the ON/RUN position.
ignition switch is in the START or ON/RUN
a collision. The Occupant Restraint Controller The Air Bag Warning Light remains on after the
position. If the ignition switch is in the OFF position,
(ORC) monitors the internal circuits and four to eight-second interval.
the air bag system is not on and the air bags will
interconnecting wiring associated with the
not inflate. The Air Bag Warning Light comes on intermit-
electrical Air Bag System Components.
tently or remains on while driving.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 214
214 SAFETY
SAFETY 215
The first stage inflator is triggered immediately On the other hand, depending on the type and
during an impact that requires air bag deployment. WARNING! location of impact, front air bags may deploy in
A low energy output is used in less severe Do not put anything on or around the air bag crashes with little vehicle front-end damage but
collisions. A higher energy output is used for more covers or attempt to open them manually. You that produce a severe initial deceleration.
severe collisions. may damage the air bags and you could be Because air bag sensors measure vehicle
This vehicle may be equipped with a driver and/or injured because the air bags may no longer be deceleration over time, vehicle speed and damage
front passenger seat belt buckle switch that functional. The protective covers for the air by themselves are not good indicators of whether
detects whether the driver or front passenger seat bag cushions are designed to open only when or not an air bag should have deployed.
belt is buckled. The seat belt buckle switch may the air bags are inflating.
Seat belts are necessary for your protection in all
adjust the inflation rate of the Advanced Front Relying on the air bags alone could lead to collisions, and also are needed to help keep you in
Air Bags. more severe injuries in a collision. The air position, away from an inflating air bag.
This vehicle may be equipped with driver and/or bags work with your seat belt to restrain you When the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
front passenger seat track position sensors that properly. In some collisions, air bags won’t detects a collision requiring the front air bags, it
may adjust the inflation rate of the Advanced Front deploy at all. Always wear your seat belts even signals the inflator units. A large quantity of
Air Bags based upon seat position. though you have air bags. non-toxic gas is generated to inflate the front
This vehicle is equipped with a right front air bags.
6
passenger Occupant Classification System (OCS) Front Air Bag Operation The steering wheel hub trim cover and the upper
that is designed to provide Passenger Advanced passenger side of the instrument panel separate
Front Air Bags are designed to provide additional
Front Air Bag output appropriate to the occupant’s and fold out of the way as the air bags inflate to
protection by supplementing the seat belts. Front
seated weight input, as determined by the OCS. their full size. The front air bags fully inflate in less
air bags are not expected to reduce the risk of
injury in rear, side, or rollover collisions. The front time than it takes to blink your eyes. The front air
WARNING! bags then quickly deflate while helping to restrain
air bags will not deploy in all frontal collisions,
No objects should be placed over or near the including some that may produce substantial the driver and front passenger.
air bag on the instrument panel or steering vehicle damage — for example, some pole
wheel because any such objects could cause collisions, truck underrides, and angle offset
harm if the vehicle is in a collision severe collisions.
enough to cause the air bag to inflate.
(Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 216
216 SAFETY
Occupant Classification System (OCS) — The OCS will NOT prevent deployment of the * It is possible for a child to be classified as an
Front Passenger Seat Passenger Advanced Front Air Bag. The OCS may adult, allowing a full-power Passenger Advanced
reduce the inflation rate of the Passenger Front Air Bag deployment. Never allow children to
The Occupant Classification System (OCS) is part of Advanced Front Air Bag if the OCS estimates that: ride in the front passenger seat and never install a
a Federally regulated safety system for this vehicle. child restraint system, including a rear-facing child
It is designed to provide Passenger Advanced Front The front passenger seat is unoccupied or has
very light objects on it; or restraint, in the front passenger seat.
Air Bag output appropriate to the occupant’s seated
weight, as determined by the OCS. The front passenger seat is occupied by a small WARNING!
The Occupant Classification System (OCS) consists passenger, including a child; or
Never place a rear-facing child restraint in
of the following: The front passenger seat is occupied by a
front of an air bag. A deploying passenger
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) rear-facing child restraint; or
front air bag can cause death or serious injury
Occupant Classification Module (OCM) and The front passenger is not properly seated or his to a child 12 years or younger, including a
Sensor located in the front passenger seat or her weight is taken off of the seat for a period child in a rear-facing child restraint.
of time.
Air Bag Warning Light Never install a rear-facing child restraint in the
Front Passenger Seat Front Passenger front seat of a vehicle. Only use a rear-facing
Occupant Classification Module (OCM) And Sensor
Occupant Status Air Bag Output child restraint in the rear seat. If the vehicle
The Occupant Classification Module (OCM) is does not have a rear seat, do not transport a
located underneath the front passenger seat. The Rear-facing child Reduced-power rear-facing child restraint in that vehicle.
Sensor is located beneath the passenger seat restraint deployment
Children 12 years or younger should always
cushion foam. Any weight on the seat will be Child, including a child
sensed by the Sensor. The OCM uses input from Reduced-power ride buckled up in the rear seat of a vehicle
in a forward-facing with a rear seat.
the Sensor to determine the front passenger’s deployment OR
child restraint or
most probable classification. The OCM Full-power deployment
booster seat*
communicates this information to the ORC. The The OCS determines the front passenger’s most
Full-power deployment
ORC may reduce the inflation rate of the Passenger probable classification. The OCS estimates the
Properly seated adult OR reduced-power
Advanced Front Air Bag deployment based on seated weight on the front passenger seat and
deployment
occupant classification. In order for the OCS to where that weight is located. The OCS
operate as designed, it is important for the front Reduced-power communicates the classification status to the ORC.
Unoccupied seat
passenger to be seated properly and properly deployment
wearing the seat belt.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 217
SAFETY 217
The ORC uses the classification to determine Lighter Weight Passengers (Including Small Adults) Examples of improper front passenger seating
whether the Passenger Advanced Front Air Bag When a lighter weight passenger, including a small include:
inflation rate should be adjusted. adult, occupies the front passenger seat, the OCS The front passenger’s weight is transferred to
In order for the OCS to operate as designed, it is may reduce the inflation rate of the Passenger another part of the vehicle (like the door, arm
important for the front passenger to be seated Advanced Front Air Bag. This does not mean that rest or instrument panel).
properly and properly wearing the seat belt. the OCS is working improperly. The front passenger leans forward, sideways, or
Properly seated passengers are: Do not decrease OR increase the front passenger’s turns to face the rear of the vehicle.
Sitting upright seated weight on the front passenger seat The front passenger’s seatback is not in the full
Facing forward The front passenger’s seated weight must be upright position.
Sitting in the center of the seat with their feet properly positioned on the front passenger seat. The front passenger carries or holds an object
comfortably on or near the floor Failure to do so may result in serious injury or while seated (e.g., backpack, box, etc.).
death. The OCS determines the most probable
Sitting with their back against the seatback and classification of the occupant that it detects. The Objects are lodged under the front passenger
the seatback in an upright position OCS will detect the front passenger’s decreased or seat.
increased seated weight, which may result in an Objects are lodged between the front passenger
adjusted inflation rate of the Passenger Advanced seat and center console. 6
Front Air Bag in a collision. This does not mean that Accessories that may change the seated weight
the OCS is working improperly. Decreasing the on the front passenger seat are attached to the
front passenger’s seated weight on the front front passenger seat.
passenger seat may result in a reduced-power
Anything that may decrease or increase the
deployment of the Passenger Advanced Front Air
Bag. Increasing the front passenger’s seated front passenger’s seated weight.
weight on the front passenger seat may result in a
full-power deployment of the Passenger Advanced
Front Air Bag.
Seated Properly
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 218
218 SAFETY
SAFETY 219
The Air Bag Warning Light in the instrument Do not replace the seat cover or cushion with an Knee Impact Bolsters
panel will turn on whenever the OCS is unable to aftermarket seat cover or cushion.
The Knee Impact Bolsters help protect the knees
classify the front passenger seat status. A Do not add a secondary seat cover or mat. of the driver and front passenger, and position the
malfunction in the OCS may affect the operation of At no time should any Supplemental Restraint front occupants for improved interaction with the
the air bag system. System (SRS) component or SRS related front air bags.
If the Air Bag Warning Light does not come on, component or fastener be modified or replaced
or stays on after you start the vehicle, or it comes with any part except those which are approved WARNING!
on as you drive, take the vehicle to an authorized by FCA US LLC. Do not drill, cut, or tamper with the knee
dealer for service immediately. impact bolsters in any way.
WARNING!
The passenger seat assembly contains critical Do not mount any accessories to the knee
OCS components that may affect the Passenger Unapproved modifications or service proce- impact bolsters such as alarm lights, stereos,
Advanced Front Air Bag inflation. In order for the OCS dures to the passenger seat assembly, its citizen band radios, etc.
to properly classify the seated weight of a front seat related components, seat cover or cushion
passenger, the OCS components must function as may inadvertently change the air bag deploy-
designed. Do not make any modifications to the front ment in case of a frontal collision. This could Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag
6
passenger seat components, assembly, or to the result in death or serious injury to the front This vehicle is equipped with a Supplemental
seat cover. If the seat, trim cover, or cushion needs passenger if the vehicle is involved in a colli- Driver Knee Air Bag mounted in the instrument
service for any reason, take the vehicle to an sion. A modified vehicle may not comply with panel below the steering column. The
authorized dealer. Only FCA US LLC approved seat required Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Stan- Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag provides
accessories may be used. dards (FMVSS) and/or Canadian Motor enhanced protection during a frontal impact by
The following requirements must be strictly Vehicle Safety Standards (CMVSS). working together with the seat belts,
followed: If it is necessary to modify the air bag system
pretensioners, and front air bags.
Do not modify the front passenger seat for persons with disabilities, contact an autho-
assembly or components in any way. rized dealer.
Do not use prior or future model year seat
covers or cushions not designated by
FCA US LLC for the specific model being
repaired. Always use the correct seat cover and
cushion specified for the vehicle.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 220
220 SAFETY
Supplemental Side Air Bags When the SAB deploys, it opens the seam on the
outboard side of the seatback’s trim cover. The
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SABs)
inflating SAB deploys through the seat seam into
This vehicle is equipped with Supplemental the space between the occupant and the door. The
Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SABs). SAB moves at a very high speed and with such a
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SABs) high force that it could injure occupants if they are
are located in the outboard side of the front seats. not seated properly, or if items are positioned in
The SABs are marked with “SRS AIRBAG” or the area where the SAB inflates. Children are at an
“AIRBAG” on a label or on the seat trim on the even greater risk of injury from a deploying air bag.
outboard side of the seats.
The SABs may help to reduce the risk of occupant
WARNING! Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain (SABIC)
injury during certain side impacts, in addition to Do not use accessory seat covers or place Label Location
the injury reduction potential provided by the seat objects between you and the Side Air Bags; the
belts and body structure. SABICs may help reduce the risk of head and other
performance could be adversely affected and/or
injuries to front and rear seat outboard occupants
objects could be pushed into you, causing
in certain side impacts, in addition to the injury
serious injury.
reduction potential provided by the seat belts and
body structure.
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains
The SABIC deploys downward, covering the side
(SABICs)
windows. An inflating SABIC pushes the outside
This vehicle is equipped with Supplemental Side edge of the headliner out of the way and covers the
Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABICs). window. The SABICs inflate with enough force to
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains injure occupants if they are not belted and seated
(SABICs) are located above the side windows. The properly, or if items are positioned in the area
trim covering the SABICs is labeled “SRS AIRBAG” where the SABICs inflate. Children are at an even
Front Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bag or “AIRBAG.” greater risk of injury from a deploying air bag.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 221
SAFETY 221
The SABICs may help reduce the risk of partial or Side Impacts Side Air Bags are a supplement to the seat belt
complete ejection of vehicle occupants through The Side Air Bags are designed to activate in restraint system. Side Air Bags deploy in less time
side windows in certain side impact events. certain side impacts. The Occupant Restraint than it takes to blink your eyes.
Controller (ORC) determines whether the
WARNING! deployment of the Side Air Bags in a particular WARNING!
Do not mount equipment, or stack luggage or impact event is appropriate, based on the severity Occupants, including children, who are up
other cargo up high enough to block the and type of collision. The side impact sensors aid against or very close to Side Air Bags can be
deployment of the SABICs. The trim covering the ORC in determining the appropriate response seriously injured or killed. Occupants,
above the side windows where the SABIC and to impact events. The system is calibrated to including children, should never lean on or
its deployment path are located should deploy the Side Air Bags on the impact side of the sleep against the door, side windows, or area
remain free from any obstructions. vehicle during impacts that require Side Air Bag where the side air bags inflate, even if they are
occupant protection. In side impacts, the Side Air in an infant or child restraint.
In order for the SABICs to work as intended, do
Bags deploy independently; a left side impact
not install any accessory items in your vehicle deploys the left Side Air Bags only and a right-side Seat belts (and child restraints where appro-
which could alter the roof. Do not add an after- impact deploys the right Side Air Bags only. Vehicle priate) are necessary for your protection in all
market sunroof to your vehicle. Do not add collisions. They also help keep you in position,
roof racks that require permanent attach-
damage by itself is not a good indicator of whether
away from an inflating Side Air Bag. To get the 6
or not Side Air Bags should have deployed.
ments (bolts or screws) for installation on the best protection from the Side Air Bags, occu-
vehicle roof. Do not drill into the roof of the The Side Air Bags will not deploy in all side pants must wear their seat belts properly and
vehicle for any reason. collisions, including some collisions at certain sit upright with their backs against the seats.
angles, or some side collisions that do not impact Children must be properly restrained in a child
the area of the passenger compartment. The Side restraint or booster seat that is appropriate for
Air Bags may deploy during angled or offset frontal the size of the child.
collisions where the front air bags deploy.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 222
222 SAFETY
SAFETY 223
If A Deployment Occurs As the air bags deflate, you may see some
smoke-like particles. The particles are a normal WARNING!
The front air bags are designed to deflate
by-product of the process that generates the Deployed air bags and seat belt pretensioners
immediately after deployment.
non-toxic gas used for air bag inflation. These cannot protect you in another collision. Have the
NOTE: airborne particles may irritate the skin, eyes, air bags, seat belt pretensioners, and the seat belt
Front and/or side air bags will not deploy in all nose, or throat. If you have skin or eye irritation, retractor assemblies replaced by an authorized
collisions. This does not mean something is wrong rinse the area with cool water. For nose or throat dealer immediately. Also, have the Occupant
with the air bag system. irritation, move to fresh air. If the irritation Restraint Controller System serviced as well.
If you do have a collision which deploys the air continues, see your doctor. If these particles
bags, any or all of the following may occur: settle on your clothing, follow the garment
manufacturer’s instructions for cleaning.
NOTE:
The air bag material may sometimes cause abra-
Air bag covers may not be obvious in the interior
sions and/or skin reddening to the occupants as Do not drive your vehicle after the air bags have
trim, but they will open during air bag deploy-
the air bags deploy and unfold. The abrasions are deployed. If you are involved in another collision,
ment.
similar to friction rope burns or those you might the air bags will not be in place to protect you.
get sliding along a carpet or gymnasium floor. After any collision, the vehicle should be taken
They are not caused by contact with chemicals. to an authorized dealer immediately. 6
They are not permanent and normally heal
quickly. However, if you haven’t healed signifi-
cantly within a few days, or if you have any blis-
tering, see your doctor immediately.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 224
224 SAFETY
Enhanced Accident Response System Your vehicle may also be designed to perform any NOTE:
of these other functions in response to the After an accident, remember to cycle the ignition to
In the event of an impact, if the communication
Enhanced Accident Response System: the STOP (OFF/LOCK) position and remove the key
network remains intact, and the power remains
intact, depending on the nature of the event, the Turn off the Fuel Filter Heater, Turn off the HVAC from the ignition switch to avoid draining the
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) will determine Blower Motor, Close the HVAC Circulation Door battery. Carefully check the vehicle for fuel leaks in
whether to have the Enhanced Accident Response the engine compartment and on the ground near
Cut off battery power to the:
System perform the following functions: the engine compartment and fuel tank before
Engine resetting the system and starting the engine. If
Cut off fuel to the engine (if equipped) there are no fuel leaks or damage to the vehicle
Electric Motor (if equipped)
Cut off battery power to the electric motor electrical devices (e.g. headlights) after an
Electric power steering
(if equipped) accident, reset the system by following the
Brake booster procedure described below. If you have any doubt,
Flash hazard lights as long as the battery has
power Electric park brake contact an authorized dealer.
Turn on the interior lights, which remain on as Automatic transmission gear selector
long as the battery has power or for 15 minutes Horn
from the intervention of the Enhanced Accident
Front wiper
Response System
Headlamp washer pump (if equipped)
Unlock the power door locks
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 225
SAFETY 225
Customer Action
NOTE: Customer Will See
Each step MUST BE held for at least two seconds
1. Turn ignition STOP/OFF/LOCK. (Turn Signal Switch Must be placed
in Neutral State).
Right turn light BLINKS.
2. Turn ignition MAR/ON/RUN.
Left turn light is OFF.
6
Right turn light is ON SOLID.
3. Turn right turn signal switch ON.
Left turn light BLINKS.
Right turn light is OFF.
4. Place turn signal in neutral state.
Left turn light BLINKS.
Right turn light BLINKS.
5. Turn left turn signal switch ON.
Left turn light is ON SOLID.
Right turn light BLINKS.
6. Place turn signal in neutral state.
Left turn light is OFF.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 226
226 SAFETY
Customer Action
NOTE: Customer Will See
Each step MUST BE held for at least two seconds
Right turn light is ON SOLID.
7. Turn right turn signal switch ON.
Left turn light BLINKS.
Right turn light is OFF.
8. Place turn signal in neutral state.
Left turn light BLINKS.
Right turn light is ON SOLID.
9. Turn left turn signal switch ON.
Left turn light is ON SOLID.
10. Turn left turn signal switch OFF. (Turn Signal Switch Must be placed Right turn light is OFF.
in Neutral State). Left turn light is OFF.
11. Turn ignition STOP/OFF/LOCK.
12. Turn ignition MAR/ON/RUN. (Entire sequence needs to be completed
System is now reset and the engine may be started.
within one minute or sequence will need to be repeated).
Turn hazard flashers OFF (Manually).
If a reset procedure step is not completed within 60 seconds, then the turn signal lights will blink and the reset procedure must be performed again in order to
be successful.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 227
SAFETY 227
228 SAFETY
NOTE: CHILD R ESTRAINTS There are different sizes and types of restraints for
EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a children from newborn size to the child almost
non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data are Everyone in your vehicle needs to be buckled up at large enough for an adult safety belt. Always check
recorded by the EDR under normal driving condi- all times, including babies and children. Every the child seat Owner’s Manual to make sure you
tions and no personal data (e.g., name, gender, state in the United States, and every Canadian have the correct seat for your child. Carefully read
age, and crash location) are recorded. However, province, requires that small children ride in and follow all the instructions and warnings in the
other parties, such as law enforcement, could proper restraint systems. This is the law, and you child restraint Owner’s Manual and on all the
combine the EDR data with the type of personally can be prosecuted for ignoring it. labels attached to the child restraint.
identifying data routinely acquired during a crash Children 12 years or younger should ride properly Before buying any restraint system, make sure that
investigation. buckled up in a rear seat, if available. According to it has a label certifying that it meets all applicable
To read data recorded by an EDR, special crash statistics, children are safer when properly Safety Standards. You should also make sure that
equipment is required, and access to the vehicle or restrained in the rear seats rather than in the front. you can install it in the vehicle where you will use it.
the EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle NOTE:
manufacturer, other parties, such as law WARNING!
enforcement, that have the special equipment, For additional information, refer to
In a collision, an unrestrained child can become http://www.nhtsa.gov/parents-and-care-
can read the information if they have access to the a projectile inside the vehicle. The force required
vehicle or the EDR. givers or call: 1–888–327–4236
to hold even an infant on your lap could become
so great that you could not hold the child, no Canadian residents should refer to Transport
matter how strong you are. The child and others Canada’s website for additional information:
could be badly injured or killed. Any child riding https://www.tc.gc.ca/en/services/road/
in your vehicle should be in a proper restraint for child-car-seat-safety.html
the child’s size.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 229
SAFETY 229
230 SAFETY
SAFETY 231
Children Too Large For Booster Seats If the answer to any of these questions was “no,”
WARNING! then the child still needs to use a booster seat in
Children who are large enough to wear the
Improper installation can lead to failure of an this vehicle. If the child is using the lap/shoulder
shoulder belt comfortably, and whose legs are long
infant or child restraint. It could come loose in belt, check seat belt fit periodically and make sure
enough to bend over the front of the seat when
a collision. The child could be badly injured or the seat belt buckle is latched. A child’s squirming
their back is against the seatback, should use the
killed. Follow the child restraint manufac- or slouching can move the belt out of position. If
seat belt in a rear seat. Use this simple 5-step test
turer’s directions exactly when installing an the shoulder belt contacts the face or neck, move
to decide whether the child can use the vehicle’s
infant or child restraint. the child closer to the center of the vehicle, or use
seat belt alone:
a booster seat to position the seat belt on the child
After a child restraint is installed in the 1. Can the child sit all the way back against the correctly.
vehicle, do not move the vehicle seat forward back of the vehicle seat?
or rearward because it can loosen the child WARNING!
2. Do the child’s knees bend comfortably over
restraint attachments. Remove the child
the front of the vehicle seat while the child is Never allow a child to put the shoulder belt
restraint before adjusting the vehicle seat
still sitting all the way back? under an arm or behind their back. In a crash,
position. When the vehicle seat has been
adjusted, reinstall the child restraint. 3. Does the shoulder belt cross the child’s the shoulder belt will not protect a child properly,
shoulder between the neck and arm? which may result in serious injury or death. 6
When your child restraint is not in use, secure A child must always wear both the lap and
it in the vehicle with the seat belt or LATCH 4. Is the lap part of the belt as low as possible,
touching the child’s thighs and not the shoulder portions of the seat belt correctly.
anchorages, or remove it from the vehicle.
Do not leave it loose in the vehicle. In a stomach?
sudden stop or accident, it could strike the 5. Can the child stay seated like this for the whole
occupants or seatbacks and cause serious trip?
personal injury.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 232
232 SAFETY
Combined Weight of Use Any Attachment Method Shown With An “X” Below
Restraint Type the Child + Child LATCH – Lower Anchors LATCH – Lower Anchors Seat Belt + Top Tether
Restraint Seat Belt Only
Only + Top Tether Anchor Anchor
Rear-Facing Up to 65 lbs
X X
Child Restraint (29.5 kg)
Rear-Facing More than 65 lbs
X
Child Restraint (29.5 kg)
Forward-Facing Up to 65 lbs
X X
Child Restraint (29.5 kg)
Forward-Facing More than 65 lbs
X
Child Restraint (29.5 kg)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 233
SAFETY 233
Lower Anchors And Tethers For CHildren Your vehicle is equipped with the child restraint LATCH Positions For Installing Child
(LATCH) Restraint System anchorage system called LATCH, which stands for Restraints In This Vehicle
Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren. The
LATCH system has three vehicle anchor points for
installing LATCH-equipped child seats. There are
two lower anchorages located at the back of the
seat cushion where it meets the seatback and one
top tether anchorage located behind the seating
position. These anchorages are used to install
LATCH-equipped child seats without using the
vehicle’s seat belts. Some seating positions may
have a top tether anchorage but no lower
LATCH Label anchorages. In these seating positions, the seat
belt must be used with the top tether anchorage to
install the child restraint. Please see the following LATCH Positions
table for more information. Lower Anchorage Symbol 6
(2 Anchorages Per Seating Position)
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 234
234 SAFETY
SAFETY 235
Locating The LATCH Anchorages Locating The Upper Tether Anchorages Center Seat LATCH
The lower anchorages are round bars There are tether strap anchorages Do not install child restraints with rigid lower
that are found at the rear of the seat behind each rear seating position attachments in the center seating position. Only
cushion where it meets the seatback, located on the back of the seat. install this type of child restraint in the outboard
below the anchorage symbols on the seating positions. Child restraints with flexible,
seatback. They are just visible when you lean into webbing mounted lower attachments can be
the rear seat to install the child restraint. You will installed in any rear seating position.
easily feel them if you run your finger along the gap
between the seatback and seat cushion. WARNING!
Never use the same lower anchorage to attach
more than one child restraint. If you are
installing LATCH-compatible child restraints next
to each other, you must use the seat belt for the
center position. You can then use either the
LATCH anchors or the vehicle’s seat belt for
Tether Anchorage Locations installing child seats in the outboard positions. 6
LATCH-compatible child restraint systems will be Please see Ú page 236 for typical installation
equipped with a rigid bar or a flexible strap on each instructions.
side. Each will have a hook or connector to attach
Lower Anchorage Location to the lower anchorage and a way to tighten the
connection to the anchorage. Forward-facing child
restraints and some rear-facing child restraints will
also be equipped with a tether strap. The tether
strap will have a hook at the end to attach to the
top tether anchorage and a way to tighten the strap
after it is attached to the anchorage.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 236
236 SAFETY
Always follow the directions of the child restraint 3. Attach the lower hooks or connectors of the behind the child restraint, route the seat belt
manufacturer when installing your child restraint. child restraint to the lower anchorages in the through the child restraint belt path and then
Not all child restraint systems will be installed as selected seating position. buckle it. Do not lock the seat belt. Remind all
described here. 4. If the child restraint has a tether strap, connect children in the vehicle that the seat belts are not
toys and that they should not play with them.
To Install A LATCH-Compatible Child it to the top tether anchorage. See
Restraint Ú page 239 for directions to attach a tether
anchor. WARNING!
If the selected seating position has a Switchable
5. Tighten all of the straps as you push the child Improper installation of a child restraint to the
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) seat belt, stow
restraint rearward and downward into the LATCH anchorages can lead to failure of the
the seat belt, following the instructions below. See
seat. Remove slack in the straps according to restraint. The child could be badly injured or
Ú page 237 to check what type of seat belt each
the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions. killed. Follow the child restraint manufac-
seating position has.
turer’s directions exactly when installing an
1. Loosen the adjusters on the lower straps and 6. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly
infant or child restraint.
on the tether strap of the child seat so that by pulling back and forth on the child seat at
you can more easily attach the hooks or the belt path. It should not move more than Child restraint anchorages are designed to
connectors to the vehicle anchorages. 1 inch (25.4 mm) in any direction. withstand only those loads imposed by
correctly-fitted child restraints. Under no
2. Place the child seat between the lower How To Stow An Unused Switchable-ALR circumstances are they to be used for adult
anchorages for that seating position. If the seat belts, harnesses, or for attaching other
second row seat can be reclined, you may
(ALR) Seat Belt:
items or equipment to the vehicle.
recline the seat and/or raise the head restraint When using the LATCH attaching system to install
(if adjustable) to get a better fit. If the rear seat a child restraint, stow all ALR seat belts that are not
can be moved forward and rearward in the being used by other occupants or being used to
vehicle, you may wish to move it to its secure child restraints. An unused belt could injure
rear-most position to make room for the child a child if they play with it and accidentally lock the
seat. You may also move the front seat forward seat belt retractor. Before installing a child
to allow more room for the child seat. restraint using the LATCH system, buckle the seat
belt behind the child restraint and out of the child’s
reach. If the buckled seat belt interferes with the
child restraint installation, instead of buckling it
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 237
SAFETY 237
Installing Child Restraints Using The The seat belts in the passenger seating positions Lap/Shoulder Belt Systems For Installing
Vehicle Seat Belt are equipped with a Switchable Automatic Locking Child Restraints In This Vehicle
Retractor (ALR) that is designed to keep the lap
Child restraint systems are designed to be secured portion of the seat belt tight around the child
in vehicle seats by lap belts or the lap belt portion restraint so that it is not necessary to use a locking
of a lap/shoulder belt. clip. The ALR retractor can be “switched” into a
locked mode by pulling all of the webbing out of the
WARNING! retractor and then letting the webbing retract back
Improper installation or failure to properly into the retractor. If it is locked, the ALR will make
secure a child restraint can lead to failure of a clicking noise while the webbing is pulled back
the restraint. The child could be badly injured into the retractor.
or killed. See the “Automatic Locking Mode” description
Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s Ú page 212 for additional information on ALR.
directions exactly when installing an infant or Please see the table below and the following Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) Locations
child restraint. sections for more information.
ALR — Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor 6
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 238
238 SAFETY
Frequently Asked Questions About Installing Child Restraints With Seat Belts
What is the weight limit (child’s weight + weight of Always use the tether anchor when using the seat
the child restraint) for using the Tether Anchor with belt to install a forward facing child restraint, up to
Weight limit of the Child Restraint
the seat belt to attach a forward facing child the recommended weight limit of the child
restraint? restraint.
Contact between the front passenger seat and the
Can the rear-facing child restraint touch the back of
Yes child restraint is allowed, if the child restraint
the front passenger seat?
manufacturer also allows contact.
Can the rear head restraints be removed? No
Can the buckle stalk be twisted to tighten the seat Do not twist the buckle stalk in a seating position
No
belt against the belt path of the child restraint? with an ALR retractor.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 239
SAFETY 239
Installing A Child Restraint With A 2. Pull enough of the seat belt webbing from the 9. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly
Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor retractor to pass it through the belt path of the by pulling back and forth on the child seat at
child restraint. Do not twist the belt webbing in the belt path. It should not move more than
(ALR): the belt path. 1 inch (25.4 mm) in any direction.
Child restraint systems are designed to be secured
3. Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you
in vehicle seats by lap belts or the lap belt portion Any seat belt system will loosen with time, so check
hear a “click.”
of a lap/shoulder belt. the belt occasionally, and pull it tight if necessary.
4. Pull on the webbing to make the lap portion
tight against the child seat. Installing Child Restraints Using The Top
WARNING!
5. To lock the seat belt, pull down on the shoulder
Tether Anchorage:
Improper installation or failure to properly
secure a child restraint can lead to failure of part of the belt until you have pulled all the
WARNING!
the restraint. The child could be badly injured seat belt webbing out of the retractor. Then,
or killed. allow the webbing to retract back into the Do not attach a tether strap for a rear-facing car
retractor. As the webbing retracts, you will hear seat to any location in front of the car seat,
Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s a clicking sound. This means the seat belt is including the seat frame or a tether anchorage.
directions exactly when installing an infant or now in the Automatic Locking mode. Only attach the tether strap of a rear-facing car
child restraint. seat to the tether anchorage that is approved for 6
6. Try to pull the webbing out of the retractor. If it
is locked, you should not be able to pull out any that seating position, located behind the top of
1. Place the child seat in the center of the webbing. If the retractor is not locked, repeat the vehicle seat. See Ú page 233 for the
seating position. If the second row seat can step 5. location of approved tether anchorages in
be reclined, you may recline the seat and/or your vehicle.
7. Finally, pull up on any excess webbing to
raise the head restraint (if adjustable) to get a
tighten the lap portion around the child
better fit. If the rear seat can be moved
restraint while you push the child restraint
forward and rearward in the vehicle, you may
rearward and downward into the vehicle seat.
wish to move it to its rear-most position to
make room for the child seat. You may also 8. If the child restraint has a top tether strap and
move the front seat forward to allow more the seating position has a top tether anchorage,
room for the child seat. connect the tether strap to the anchorage and
tighten the tether strap. See Ú page 239 for
directions to attach a tether anchor.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 240
240 SAFETY
TRANSPORTING P ASSENGERS
NEVER TRANSPORT PASSENGERS IN THE CARGO
AREA.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 241
SAFETY 241
242 SAFETY
WARNING! WARNING!
PERIODIC S AFETY CHECKS YOU SHOULD
ONLY use the driver’s side floor mat on the NEVER place any objects under the floor mat
MAKE OUTSIDE T HE V EHICLE
driver’s side floor area. To check for interfer- (e.g., towels, keys, etc.). These objects could Tires
ence, with the vehicle properly parked with the change the position of the floor mat and may
Examine tires for excessive tread wear and uneven
engine off, fully depress the accelerator, the cause interference with the accelerator,
wear patterns. Check for stones, nails, glass, or
brake, and the clutch pedal (if present) to brake, or clutch pedals.
other objects lodged in the tread or sidewall.
check for interference. If your floor mat inter-
If the vehicle carpet has been removed and Inspect the tread for cuts and cracks. Inspect
feres with the operation of any pedal, or is not
re-installed, always properly attach carpet to sidewalls for cuts, cracks, and bulges. Check the
secure to the floor, remove the floor mat from
the floor and check the floor mat fasteners are lug nut/bolt torque for tightness. Check the tires
the vehicle and place the floor mat in your
secure to the vehicle carpet. Fully depress (including spare) for proper cold inflation pressure.
trunk.
each pedal to check for interference with the Lights
ONLY use the passenger’s side floor mat on accelerator, brake, or clutch pedals then
the passenger’s side floor area. re-install the floor mats. Have someone observe the operation of brake
lights and exterior lights while you work the
ALWAYS make sure objects cannot fall or slide It is recommended to only use mild soap and controls. Check turn signal and high beam
into the driver’s side floor area when the water to clean your floor mats. After cleaning, indicator lights on the instrument panel.
vehicle is moving. Objects can become always check your floor mat has been properly
trapped under accelerator, brake, or clutch installed and is secured to your vehicle using Door Latches
pedals and could cause a loss of vehicle the floor mat fasteners by lightly pulling mat. Check for proper closing, latching, and locking.
control. Fluid Leaks
(Continued) Check area under the vehicle after overnight
parking for fuel, coolant, oil, or other fluid leaks.
Also, if gasoline fumes are detected or if fuel or
brake fluid leaks are suspected, the cause should
be located and corrected immediately.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 243
SAFETY 243
EXHAUST GAS The best protection against carbon monoxide entry CARBON M ONOXIDE W ARNINGS
into the vehicle body is a properly maintained
WARNING! engine exhaust system. WARNING!
Whenever a change is noticed in the sound of the
Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain exhaust system, when exhaust fumes can be Carbon monoxide (CO) in exhaust gases is
carbon monoxide (CO), which is colorless and detected inside the vehicle, or when the underside deadly. Follow the precautions below to prevent
odorless. Breathing it can make you or rear of the vehicle is damaged, have an carbon monoxide poisoning:
unconscious and can eventually poison you. To authorized dealer inspect the complete exhaust Do not inhale exhaust gases. They contain
avoid breathing (CO), follow these safety tips: system and adjacent body areas for broken, carbon monoxide, a colorless and odorless
Do not run the engine in a closed garage or in damaged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. gas, which can kill. Never run the engine in a
confined areas any longer than needed to Open seams or loose connections could permit closed area, such as a garage, and never sit in
move your vehicle in or out of the area. exhaust fumes to seep into the passenger a parked vehicle with the engine running for
compartment. In addition, inspect the exhaust an extended period. If the vehicle is stopped in
If you are required to drive with the trunk/lift-
system each time the vehicle is raised for an open area with the engine running for more
gate/rear doors open, make sure that all
lubrication or oil change. Replace as required. than a short period, adjust the ventilation
windows are closed and the climate control
BLOWER switch is set at high speed. DO NOT
system to force fresh, outside air into the 6
vehicle.
use the recirculation mode.
Guard against carbon monoxide with proper
If it is necessary to sit in a parked vehicle with
maintenance. Have the exhaust system
the engine running, adjust your heating or
inspected every time the vehicle is raised.
cooling controls to force outside air into the
Have any abnormal conditions repaired
vehicle. Set the blower at high speed.
promptly. Until repaired, drive with all side
windows fully open.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 244
244
IN CASE OF EMERGENCY
HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS This is an emergency warning system and it should
not be used when the vehicle is in motion. Use it WARNING!
The Hazard Warning Flashers button is located in only when your vehicle is disabled or signaling a ALWAYS obey traffic laws and pay attention to
the lower center area of the instrument panel. safety hazard warning for other motorists. the road. ALWAYS drive safely with your hands on
NOTE: When you must leave the vehicle to seek the steering wheel. You have full responsibility
Your vehicle may be equipped with an Emergency assistance, the Hazard Warning Flashers will and assume all risks related to the use of the
Stop Signal (ESS) Ú page 191. continue to operate even though the ignition is features and applications in this vehicle. Only
placed in the OFF position. use the features and applications when it is safe
to do so. Failure to do so may result in an
NOTE: accident involving serious injury or death.
With extended use, the Hazard Warning Flashers
may wear down your battery.
NOTE:
SOS MIRROR — IF EQUIPPED Your vehicle may be transmitting data as autho-
rized by the subscriber Ú page 328.
The SOS button will only function if you are
connected to an operable LTE (voice/data) or
4G (data) network, which comes as a built in
Hazard Warning Flashers Button function. Other Uconnect services will only be
operable if your SiriusXM Guardian™ service is
Push the button to turn on the Hazard Warning active and you are connected to an operable
Flashers. When the button is activated, all LTE (voice/data) or 4G (data) network.
directional turn signals will flash on and off to warn
oncoming traffic of an emergency. Push the button SOS Mirror
a second time to turn off the Hazard Warning
Flashers. If equipped, the Rearview mirror contains an
SOS button.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 245
SOS Call 4. You should be able to speak with the SOS The vehicle’s SOS Call system will attempt
1. Press or hold the SOS Call button on the operator through the vehicle audio system to to remain connected with the SOS operator
Rearview Mirror. determine if additional assistance is needed. until the SOS operator terminates the
connection.
NOTE: WARNING!
In case the SOS Call button is pushed in error, 5. The SOS operator may attempt to contact
there will be a 10 second delay before the SOS Call ALWAYS obey traffic laws and pay attention to appropriate emergency responders and
system initiates a call to a SOS operator. To cancel the road. ALWAYS drive safely with your hands on provide them with important vehicle
the SOS Call connection, push the SOS call button the steering wheel. You have full responsibility information and GPS coordinates.
on the Rearview Mirror or press the cancellation and assume all risks related to the use of the
button on the Device Screen. Termination of the features and applications in this vehicle. Only WARNING!
SOS Call will turn off the green LED light on the use the features and applications when it is safe
to do so. Failure to do so may result in an If anyone in the vehicle could be in danger
Rearview Mirror.
accident involving serious injury or death. (e.g., fire or smoke is visible, dangerous road
2. The LED light located next to the SOS button conditions or location), do not wait for voice
on the Rearview Mirror will turn green once a contact from an Emergency Services Agent. All
connection to a SOS operator has been made. NOTE: occupants should exit the vehicle immediately
3. Once a connection between the vehicle and a Your vehicle may be transmitting data as and move to a safe location.
SOS operator is made, the SOS Call system authorized by the subscriber.
Never place anything on or near the vehicle’s 7
may transmit the following important vehicle Once a connection is made between the operable network and GPS antennas. You
information to a SOS operator: vehicle’s SOS Call system and the SOS oper- could prevent operable network and GPS
Indication that the occupant placed a ator, the SOS operator may be able to open signal reception, which can prevent your
SOS Call a voice connection with the vehicle to deter- vehicle from placing an emergency call. An
mine if additional assistance is needed. operable network and GPS signal reception is
The vehicle brand
Once the SOS operator opens a voice required for the SOS Call system to function
The last known GPS coordinates of the connection with the vehicle’s SOS Call properly.
vehicle system, the operator should be able to
speak with you or other vehicle occupants (Continued)
and hear sounds occurring in the vehicle.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 246
If the SOS Call system detects a malfunction, any Even if the SOS Call system is fully functional,
WARNING! of the following may occur at the time the factors beyond FCA US LLC’s control may prevent
The SOS Call system is embedded into the malfunction is detected, and at the beginning of or stop the SOS Call system operation. These
vehicle’s electrical system. Do not add after- each ignition cycle: include, but are not limited to, the following
market electrical equipment to the vehicle’s The Rearview Mirror light located next to the factors:
electrical system. This may prevent your SOS button will continuously illuminate red. The ignition is in the OFF position
vehicle from sending a signal to initiate an
The Device Screen will display the following The vehicle’s electrical systems are not intact
emergency call. To avoid interference that can
message “Vehicle device requires service. The SOS Call system software and/or hardware
cause the SOS Call system to fail, never add
Please contact an authorized dealer.” are damaged during a crash
aftermarket equipment (e.g., two-way mobile
radio, CB radio, data recorder, etc.) to your An In-Vehicle Audio message will state “Vehicle The vehicle battery loses power or becomes
vehicle’s electrical system or modify the device requires service. Please contact an disconnected during a vehicle crash
antennas on your vehicle. IF YOUR VEHICLE authorized dealer.”
LTE (voice/data) or 4G (data) network and/or
LOSES BATTERY POWER FOR ANY REASON
WARNING! Global Positioning Satellite signals are unavail-
(INCLUDING DURING OR AFTER AN ACCI-
able or obstructed
DENT), THE UCONNECT FEATURES, APPS AND Ignoring the Rearview Mirror light could mean
SERVICES, AMONG OTHERS, WILL NOT Equipment malfunction at the SOS operator
you will not have SOS Call services. If the Rear-
OPERATE. facility
view Mirror light is illuminated, have an autho-
rized dealer service the SOS Call system Operator error by the SOS operator
Modifications to any part of the SOS Call
system could cause the air bag system to fail immediately. LTE (voice/data) or 4G (data) network conges-
when you need it. You could be injured if the The Occupant Restraint Control module turns tion
air bag system is not there to help protect you. on the air bag Warning Light on the instrument Weather
panel if a malfunction in any part of the Buildings, structures, geographic terrain, or
SOS Call System Limitations system is detected. If the Air Bag Warning tunnels
Light is illuminated, have an authorized dealer
Vehicles sold in Mexico DO NOT have SOS Call
service the Occupant Restraint Control system
system capabilities.
immediately.
SOS or other emergency line operators in Mexico
may not answer or respond to SOS system calls.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 247
WARNING!
NOTE:
Changes or modifications not expressly approved
JACKING AND TIRE CHANGING —
ALWAYS obey traffic laws and pay attention to by the party responsible for compliance could void IF EQUIPPED
the road. ALWAYS drive safely with your hands on the user's authority to operate the equipment.
the steering wheel. You have full responsibility WARNING!
and assume all risks related to the use of the CAUTION!
Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of
features and applications in this vehicle. Only To avoid damage to the mirror during cleaning, the vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far
use the features and applications when it is safe never spray any cleaning solution directly onto enough off the road to avoid the danger of
to do so. Failure to do so may result in an the mirror. Apply the solution onto a clean cloth being hit when operating the jack or changing
accident involving serious injury or death. and wipe the mirror clean. the wheel.
Being under a jacked-up vehicle is dangerous.
NOTE: Automatic SOS — If Equipped The vehicle could slip off the jack and fall on
Your vehicle may be transmitting data as autho- Automatic SOS is a hands-free safety service that you. You could be crushed. Never put any part
rized by the subscriber Ú page 328. can immediately connect you with help in the event of your body under a vehicle that is on a jack.
Never place anything on or near the vehicle’s that your vehicle’s airbags deploy. Please refer to If you need to get under a raised vehicle,
LTE (voice/data) or 4G (data) and GPS your provided radio supplement for complete take it to a service center where it can be
antennas. You could prevent LTE (voice/data) or information. raised on a lift.
4G (data) and GPS signal reception, which can Never start or run the engine while the vehicle 7
prevent your vehicle from placing an emergency is on a jack.
call. An operable LTE (voice/data) or 4G (data)
network connection and a GPS signal is The jack is designed to be used as a tool for
required for the SOS Call system to function changing tires only. The jack should not be
properly. used to lift the vehicle for service purposes.
The vehicle should be jacked on a firm level
surface only. Avoid ice or slippery areas.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 248
PREPARATIONS FOR J ACKING 5. Block both the front and rear of the wheel J ACK L OCATION/SPARE T IRE S TOWAGE
diagonally opposite the jacking position. For
1. Park the vehicle on a firm level surface as far example, if the driver’s front wheel is being If equipped, the jack and tools are located in the
from the edge of the roadway as possible. changed, block the passenger’s rear wheel. rear storage compartment, below the spare tire.
Avoid icy or slippery areas. NOTE:
Items may vary depending on the trim level.
WARNING!
Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of
the vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far
enough off the road to avoid being hit when
operating the jack or changing the wheel.
1. Open the liftgate. 3. Remove the fastener securing the spare tire,
2. Lift the access cover using the load floor and remove the spare wheel from the vehicle.
handle. The jack will be found beneath.
WARNING!
A loose tire or jack thrown forward in a collision
or hard stop could endanger the occupants of
the vehicle. Always stow the jack parts and the
spare tire in the places provided. Have the
Spare Tire Removal deflated (flat) tire repaired or replaced
immediately.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 250
CAUTION!
Be sure to mount the spare tire with the valve
stem facing outward. The vehicle could be
damaged if the spare tire is mounted incorrectly.
Front Lifting Point 7
NOTE: 12. Lower the jack until it is free. Remove the 14. Place the jack on the foam tray and open it far
For vehicles equipped, do not attempt to wheel blocks. Reassemble the lug wrench to enough so that it is secured. Once placed in
install a center cap or wheel cover on the the jack assembly and stow it in the spare tire position, rotate it clockwise to lock it in.
compact spare. area. Secure the assembly using the means Replace the alignment pin in the center hole to
provided. Release the parking brake before lock the jack in place.
For additional warnings, cautions, and infor-
driving the vehicle.
mation about the spare tire, its use, and
operation Ú page 298. WARNING!
9. Install and lightly tighten the wheel bolts. A loose tire or jack thrown forward in a collision
or hard stop could endanger the occupants of
WARNING! the vehicle. Always stow the jack parts and the
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the spare tire in the places provided. Have the
jack, do not tighten the wheel nuts fully until the deflated (flat) tire repaired or replaced
vehicle has been lowered. Failure to follow this immediately.
warning may result in serious injury.
TIRE SERVICE KIT — IF EQUIPPED
10. Lower the vehicle to the ground by turning the Damaged Tire Stowage Your vehicle may be equipped with a Tire Service
jack handle counterclockwise.
Kit. Small punctures up to 1/4 inch (6 mm) in the
11. Finish tightening the wheel bolts. Push down 13. After 25 miles (40 km), check the wheel bolt
tire tread can be sealed with Tire Service Kit.
on the wrench while at the end of the handle torque with a torque wrench to ensure that all
Foreign objects (e.g., screws or nails) should not be
for increased leverage. Tighten the wheel bolts wheel bolts are properly seated against the
removed from the tire. Tire Service Kit can be used
in a star pattern until each wheel bolt has been wheel.
in outside temperatures down to approximately
tightened twice Ú page 319. If in doubt about -4°F (-20°C). This kit will provide a temporary tire
the correct tightness, have them checked with seal, allowing you to drive your vehicle up to
a torque wrench by an authorized dealer or at 100 miles (160 km) with a maximum speed of
a service station. 50 mph (80 km/h).
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 253
Tire Service Kit Storage Tire Service Kit And Components And Operation Using The Mode Select Knob And Hoses
The Tire Service Kit is stowed under the load floor Your Tire Service Kit is equipped with the following
behind the rear seat. symbols to indicate the air or sealant mode.
1. Open the liftgate. Selecting Air Mode
2. Lift the access cover using the load floor Push in the Mode Select Knob and
handle. turn to this position for air pump
operation only.
Selecting Sealant Mode
Push in the Mode Select Knob and
turn to this position to inject the
Tire Service Kit Components Tire Service Kit Sealant and to
inflate the tire.
1 — Sealant/Air Hose Using The Power Button
2 — Hose Accessories
Push and release the Power Button
3 — Mode Select Knob once to turn the Tire Service Kit on.
4 — Pressure Gauge Push and release the Power Button
Load Floor Handle 5 — Deflation Button again to turn the Tire Service Kit off. 7
6 — Power Switch Using The Deflation Button
7 — Sealant Bottle Push the Deflation Button to reduce
8 — Power Plug the air pressure in the tire if it
becomes overinflated.
Tire Service Kit Usage Precautions Sealant is only intended to seal punctures less
than 1/4 inch (6 mm) diameter in the tread of WARNING!
Replace the Tire Service Kit Sealant Bottle prior
to the expiration date (printed at the lower right your vehicle. Keep Tire Service Kit away from open flames
hand corner on the bottle label) to ensure Do not lift or carry the Tire Service Kit by the or heat source.
optimum operation of the system. hoses. A loose Tire Service Kit thrown forward in a
The Sealant Bottle is a one tire application use collision or hard stop could endanger the
and needs to be replaced after each use. Always WARNING! occupants of the vehicle. Always stow the Tire
replace these components immediately at your Do not attempt to seal a tire on the side of the Service Kit in the place provided. Failure to
original equipment vehicle dealer. vehicle closest to traffic. Pull far enough off follow these warnings can result in injuries
When the Tire Service Kit sealant is in a liquid the road to avoid the danger of being hit when that are serious or fatal to you, your passen-
form, clean water, and a damp cloth will remove using the Tire Service Kit. gers, and others around you.
the material from the vehicle or tire and wheel Do not use Tire Service Kit or drive the vehicle Take care not to allow the contents of Tire
components. Once the sealant dries, it can under the following circumstances: Service Kit to come in contact with hair, eyes,
easily be peeled off and properly discarded. or clothing. Tire Service Kit sealant is harmful
If the puncture in the tire tread is approxi-
For optimum performance, make sure the valve if inhaled, swallowed, or absorbed through the
mately 1/4 inch (6 mm) or larger. skin. It causes skin, eye, and respiratory irrita-
stem on the wheel is free of debris before
connecting the Tire Service Kit. If the tire has any sidewall damage. tion. Flush immediately with plenty of water if
there is any contact with eyes or skin. Change
You can use the Tire Service Kit air pump to If the tire has any damage from driving
clothing as soon as possible, if there is any
inflate bicycle tires. The kit also comes with two with extremely low tire pressure.
contact with clothing.
needles, located in the Accessory Storage
If the tire has any damage from driving on
Compartment (on the bottom of the air pump) Tire Service Kit Sealant solution contains
a flat tire.
for inflating sport balls, rafts, or similar inflat- latex. In case of an allergic reaction or rash,
able items. However, use only the Air Pump and If the wheel has any damage. consult a physician immediately. Keep Tire
make sure the Mode Select Knob is in the Air Service Kit out of reach of children. If swal-
If you are unsure of the condition of the
Mode when inflating such items to avoid lowed, rinse mouth immediately with plenty of
tire or the wheel.
injecting sealant into them. The Tire Service Kit water and drink plenty of water. Do not induce
(Continued) vomiting! Consult a physician immediately.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 255
Sealing A Tire With Tire Service Kit 3. Remove the cap from the valve If the sealant (white fluid) does not flow within
Whenever You Stop To Use Tire Service Kit: stem and then screw the fitting at the 0 – 10 seconds through the Sealant Hose:
end of the Sealant Hose onto the 1. Push the Power Button to turn the Tire Service
1. Pull over to a safe location and turn on the valve stem.
vehicle’s Hazard Warning Flashers. Kit off. Disconnect the Sealant Hose from the
4. Uncoil the Power Plug and insert valve stem. Make sure the valve stem is free
2. Verify that the valve stem (on the wheel with the plug into the vehicle’s 12 Volt of debris. Reconnect the Sealant Hose to the
the deflated tire) is in a position that is near to power outlet. valve stem. Check that the Mode Select Knob
the ground. This will allow the Tire Service Kit is in the Sealant Mode position and not Air
Hose to reach the valve stem and keep the Tire NOTE: Mode. Push the Power Button to turn the Tire
Service Kit flat on the ground. This will provide Do not remove foreign objects (e.g., screws or Service Kit on.
the best positioning of the kit when injecting nails) from the tire.
the sealant into the deflated tire and running 2. Connect the Power Plug to a different 12 Volt
Injecting Tire Service Kit Sealant Into The Deflated power outlet in your vehicle or another vehicle,
the air pump. Move the vehicle as necessary to
Tire: if available. Make sure the vehicle is running
place the valve stem in this position before
proceeding. 1. Always start the vehicle before before turning the Tire Service Kit on.
turning the Tire Service Kit on. 3. The Sealant Bottle may be empty due to
3. Place the transmission in PARK and cycle the
ignition in the OFF position. previous use. Call for assistance.
4. Apply the parking brake. 2. Ensure the Mode Select Knob is to
the Sealant Mode position.
If the sealant (white fluid) does flow through the 7
Sealant Hose:
Setting Up To Use Tire Service Kit:
1. Continue to operate the pump
1. Uncoil the Sealant Hose and then remove the 3. After pushing the Power Button, until sealant is no longer flowing
cap from the fitting at the end of the hose. the sealant (white fluid) will flow from through hose (typically takes
2. Place the Tire Service Kit flat on the ground the Sealant Bottle through the 30 - 70 seconds). As the sealant
next to the deflated tire. Sealant Hose and into the tire. flows through the Sealant Hose, the Pressure
Gauge can read as high as 70 psi (4.8 Bar).
NOTE:
The Pressure Gauge will decrease quickly
Sealant may leak out through the puncture in
from approximately 70 psi (4.8 Bar) to the
the tire.
actual tire pressure when the Sealant Bottle
is empty.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 256
2. The pump will start to inject air into 3. Immediately disconnect the Sealant Hose After Driving:
the tire immediately after the from the valve stem, reinstall the cap on the Pull over to a safe location.
Sealant Bottle is empty. Continue to fitting at the end of the hose, and place the Tire
operate the pump and inflate the tire Service Kit in the vehicle storage location. 1. Uncoil the Sealant Hose, and then remove the
to the cold tire inflation pressure found on the cap from the fitting at the end of the hose.
tire and loading information label located in Drive Vehicle: 2. Place the Tire Service Kit flat on the ground
the driver-side door opening. Check the tire Immediately after injecting sealant next to the deflated tire.
pressure by looking at the Pressure Gauge. and inflating the tire, drive the vehicle 3. Remove the cap from the valve
5 miles (8 km) or 10 minutes to ensure stem, and then screw the fitting at
If the tire does not inflate to at least 26 psi distribution of the Tire Service Kit Sealant the end of the Sealant Hose onto the
(1.8 Bar) pressure within 15 minutes: within the tire. Do not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h). valve stem.
The tire is too badly damaged. Do not attempt to
drive the vehicle further. Call for assistance. WARNING! 4. Uncoil the power plug and insert
the plug into the vehicle's 12 Volt
If the tire inflates to the recommended pressure or The Tire Service Kit is not a permanent flat tire power outlet.
is at least 26 psi (1.8 Bar) pressure within repair. Have the tire inspected and repaired or
15 minutes: replaced after using the Tire Service Kit. Do not 5. Uncoil the Hose and screw the
NOTE: exceed 50 mph (80 km/h) until the tire is fitting at the end of the hose onto the
If the tire becomes overinflated, push the Deflation repaired or replaced. Failure to follow this valve stem.
Button to reduce the tire pressure to the recom- warning can result in injuries that are serious or
6. Turn the Mode Select Knob and
mended inflation pressure before continuing. fatal to you, your passengers, and others around
turn to the Air Mode position.
you. Have the tire checked as soon as possible
1. Push the Power Button to turn off
at an authorized dealer.
the Tire Service Kit.
7. Check the pressure in the tire by reading the
Pressure Gauge.
2. Remove the speed limit label from
the Tire Service Kit and place sticker
on the steering wheel.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 257
If tire pressure is less than 19 psi (1.3 Bar): 5. Remove the Speed Limit sticker from the 3. Remove the bottle cover.
The tire is too badly damaged. Do not attempt to steering wheel after the tire has been repaired.
drive the vehicle further. Call for assistance. 6. Replace the Sealant Bottle at an authorized
If the tire pressure is 19 psi (1.3 Bar) or higher: dealer as soon as possible.
1. Push the Power Button to turn on NOTE:
Tire Service Kit and inflate the tire to When having the tire serviced, advise the autho-
the cold tire inflation pressure found rized dealer or service center that the tire has been
on the tire and loading information sealed using the Tire Service Kit.
label located in the driver-side door opening.
Sealant Bottle Replacement:
NOTE: 1. Unwrap the power cord.
If the tire becomes overinflated, push the Deflation
Button to reduce the tire pressure to the recom- 2. Unwrap the hose. Remove The Bottle Cover
mended inflation pressure before continuing. 4. Rotate the bottle up beyond vertical to release.
2. Disconnect the Tire Service Kit from the valve
stem, reinstall the cap on the valve stem and
unplug from 12 Volt outlet.
3. Place the Tire Service Kit in its proper storage 7
area in the vehicle.
4. Have the tire inspected and repaired or
replaced at the earliest opportunity at an
authorized dealer or tire service center.
5. Pull the bottle away from the Compressor. JUMP STARTING PREPARATIONS FOR J UMP START
If your vehicle has a discharged battery, it can be The battery in your vehicle is located in the front of
jump started using a set of jumper cables and a the engine compartment, behind the left headlight
battery in another vehicle or by using a portable assembly.
battery booster pack. Jump starting can be
dangerous if done improperly, so please follow the
procedures in this section carefully.
NOTE:
When using a portable battery booster pack, follow
the manufacturer’s operating instructions and
precautions.
Remove The Bottle
WARNING!
NOTE:
Do not attempt jump starting if the battery is
For sealant bottle installation, follow these frozen. It could rupture or explode and cause
steps in reverse order. Positive (+) Battery Post
personal injury.
Replacement sealant bottles are available at NOTE:
authorized service centers. The positive (+) battery post is covered with a
CAUTION! protective cap. Lift up on the cap to gain access to
the post.
Do not use a portable battery booster pack or
any other booster source with a system voltage See below steps to prepare for jump starting:
greater than 12 Volts or damage to the battery, 1. Apply the parking brake, shift the automatic
starter motor, alternator or electrical system transmission into PARK (P) and turn the
may occur. ignition to OFF.
2. Turn off the heater, radio, and all electrical
accessories.
3. Pull upward and remove the protective cover
over the positive (+) battery post.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 259
4. If using another vehicle to jump start the J UMP S TARTING P ROCEDURE an accessory bracket or large bolt. The ground
battery, park the vehicle within the jumper must be away from the battery and the fuel
cables reach, set the parking brake and make WARNING! injection system.
sure the ignition is OFF.
Failure to follow this jump starting procedure
could result in personal injury or property
WARNING! damage due to battery explosion.
Take care to avoid the radiator cooling fan
whenever the hood is raised. It can start
anytime the ignition switch is ON. You can be CAUTION!
injured by moving fan blades.
Failure to follow these procedures could result in
Remove any metal jewelry such as rings, damage to the charging system of the booster
watch bands and bracelets that could make vehicle or the discharged vehicle.
an inadvertent electrical contact. You could be
seriously injured. Jump Starting Label
Connecting The Jumper Cables
Batteries contain sulfuric acid that can burn 1. Connect the positive (+) end of the jumper WARNING!
your skin or eyes and generate hydrogen gas cable to the positive (+) post of the discharged
which is flammable and explosive. Keep open vehicle. Do not connect the jumper cable to the 7
flames or sparks away from the battery. negative (-) post of the discharged battery. The
2. Connect the opposite end of the positive (+) resulting electrical spark could cause the battery
jumper cable to the positive (+) post of the to explode and could result in personal injury.
booster battery.
WARNING!
3. Connect the negative (-) end of the jumper
Do not allow vehicles to touch each other as this 5. Start the engine in the vehicle that has the
cable to the negative (-) post of the booster
could establish a ground connection and booster battery, let the engine idle for a few
battery.
personal injury could result. minutes, and then start the engine in the
4. Connect the opposite end of the negative (-) vehicle with the discharged battery.
jumper cable to a good engine ground. A
6. Once the engine is started, follow the discon-
“ground” is an exposed metallic/unpainted
necting procedure below.
part of the engine, frame or chassis, such as
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 260
Disconnecting The Jumper Cables REFUELING IN EMERGENCY Emergency Gas Can Refueling
1. Disconnect the negative (-) end of the jumper Most gas cans will not open the flapper doors. A
cable from the engine ground of the vehicle The vehicle is equipped with a refueling funnel for funnel is provided to allow emergency refueling
with the discharged battery. a Capless Fuel System. If refueling is necessary, with a gas can.
while using an approved gas can, insert the
2. Disconnect the opposite end of the negative (-) refueling funnel into the filler neck opening. Take See below steps for refueling:
jumper cable from the negative (-) post of the care to open both flappers with the funnel to avoid 1. Retrieve funnel from the spare tire storage
booster battery. spills. area.
3. Disconnect the positive (+) end of the jumper NOTE: 2. Insert funnel into same filler pipe opening as
cable from the positive (+) post of the booster In certain cold conditions, ice may prevent the fuel the fuel nozzle.
battery. door from opening. If this occurs, lightly push on
4. Disconnect the opposite end of the positive (+) the fuel door to break the ice buildup and
jumper cable from the positive (+) post of the re-release the fuel door using the inside release
vehicle with the discharged battery. button. Do not pry on the door.
CAUTION!
Accessories plugged into the vehicle power
outlets draw power from the vehicle’s battery, Inserting Funnel
even when not in use (i.e., cellular devices, etc.).
3. Ensure funnel is inserted fully to hold flapper
Eventually, if plugged in long enough without
doors open.
engine operation, the vehicle’s battery will
discharge sufficiently to degrade battery life Fuel Funnel Location 4. Pour fuel into funnel opening.
and/or prevent the engine from starting.
CAUTION!
To avoid fuel spillage and overfilling, do not
“top off” the fuel tank after filling.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 261
Proper towing or lifting equipment is required to Vehicles with a discharged battery, or total elec- If the vehicle’s battery is discharged, instructions
prevent damage to your vehicle. Use only tow bars trical failure when the Electric Park Brake (EPB) on shifting the automatic transmission out of PARK
and other equipment designed for this purpose, is engaged, will need a wheel dolly or jack to so that the vehicle can be moved Ú page 262.
following equipment manufacturer’s instructions. raise the rear wheels off the ground when
Use of safety chains is mandatory. Attach a tow bar moving the vehicle onto a flatbed. CAUTION!
or other towing devices to main structural If you must use the accessories (wipers, Do not use sling-type equipment when towing.
members of the vehicle, not to fascia/bumper or defrosters, etc.) while being towed, the ignition Vehicle damage may occur.
associated brackets. State and local laws must be in the ON/RUN mode.
regarding vehicles under tow must be observed. When securing the vehicle to a flatbed truck,
Note that the Safehold feature will engage the do not attach to front or rear suspension
NOTE: Electric Park Brake whenever the driver's door is components. Damage to your vehicle may
You must ensure that the Auto Park Brake opened (if the battery is connected, ignition is ON, result from improper towing.
feature is disabled before towing this vehicle to transmission is not in PARK, and brake pedal is
avoid inadvertent Electric Park Brake engage- released). If you are towing this vehicle with the Ensure that the Electric Park Brake is
ment. The Auto Park Brake feature is enabled or ignition in the ON/RUN mode, you must manually released, and remains released, while being
disabled via the customer programmable disable the Electric Park Brake each time the towed.
features in the Uconnect Settings. driver's door is opened by pressing the brake pedal Do not use a fascia/bumper mounted
and then releasing the EPB. clamp-on tow bar on your vehicle. The fascia/
bumper face bar will be damaged.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 265
267
MAINTENANCE P LAN
Refer to the Maintenance Plan for the required maintenance intervals.
NOTE:
Using white lithium grease, lubricate the door hinge roller pivot joints twice a year to prevent premature wear.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 269
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
20,000
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
Mileage or time passed
(whichever comes first)
Or Years: 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
32,000
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
Or Kilometers:
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
20,000
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
Mileage or time passed
(whichever comes first)
Or Years: 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
32,000
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
Or Kilometers:
1. The spark plug change interval is mileage based only; yearly intervals do not apply.
WARNING!
You can be badly injured working on or around a motor vehicle. Do only service work for which you have the knowledge and the right equipment.
If you have any doubt about your ability to perform a service job, take your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
Failure to properly inspect and maintain your vehicle could result in a component malfunction and effect vehicle handling and performance.
This could cause an accident.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 271
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
2.4L E NGINE
Synthetic engine oils which do not have both the ENGINE AIR CLEANER F ILTER WARNING!
correct API trademark and the correct SAE viscosity
grade numbers should not be used. For the proper maintenance intervals Ú page 268. Use only refrigerants and compressor lubri-
Materials Added To Engine Oil cants approved by the manufacturer for your
WARNING! air conditioning system. Some unapproved
The manufacturer strongly recommends against refrigerants are flammable and can explode,
The air induction system (air cleaner, hoses,
the addition of any additives (other than leak injuring you. Other unapproved refrigerants or
etc.) can provide a measure of protection in the
detection dyes) to the engine oil. Engine oil is an lubricants can cause the system to fail,
case of engine backfire. Do not remove the air
engineered product and its performance may be requiring costly repairs. Refer to Warranty Infor-
induction system (air cleaner, hoses, etc.) unless
impaired by supplemental additives. mation Book, located in your owner’s informa-
such removal is necessary for repair or
Disposing Of Used Engine Oil And Oil maintenance. Make sure that no one is near the tion kit, for further warranty information.
Filters engine compartment before starting the vehicle The air conditioning system contains refrig-
with the air induction system (air cleaner, hoses, erant under high pressure. To avoid risk of
Care should be taken in disposing of used engine
etc.) removed. Failure to do so can result in personal injury or damage to the system,
oil and oil filters from your vehicle. Used oil and oil
serious personal injury. adding refrigerant or any repair requiring lines
filters, indiscriminately discarded, can present a
problem to the environment. Contact an to be disconnected should be done by an
authorized dealer, service station or governmental Engine Air Cleaner Filter Selection experienced technician.
agency for advice on how and where used oil and The quality of replacement filters varies
oil filters can be safely discarded in your area. considerably. Only high quality Mopar® certified
filters should be used. CAUTION!
ENGINE OIL FILTER
Do not use chemical flushes in your air conditioning
The engine oil filter should be replaced with a new AIR CONDITIONER M AINTENANCE system as the chemicals can damage your air
filter at every engine oil change. For best possible performance, your air conditioner conditioning components. Such damage is not
Engine Oil Filter Selection should be checked and serviced by an authorized covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
A full-flow type disposable oil filter should be used dealer at the start of each warm season. This
for replacement. The quality of replacement filters service should include cleaning of the condenser
varies considerably. Only high quality Mopar® fins and a performance test. Drive belt tension
certified filters should be used. should also be checked at this time.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 275
Front Wiper Blade Removal/Installation 2. To disengage the wiper blade from the wiper 3. Tilt the lower end of the wiper blade away from
arm, flip up the locking tab. the arm and with one finger push the release
CAUTION! tab toward the wiper arm.
Do not allow the wiper arm to spring back
against the glass without the wiper blade in
place or the glass may be damaged.
5. With the wiper blade disengaged, remove the Installing The Front Wipers Rear Wiper Blade Removal/Installation
wiper blade from the wiper arm by holding the 1. Lift the wiper arm off of the glass, until the 1. Lift the rear wiper arm pivot cap away from
wiper arm with one hand and separating the wiper arm is in the full up position. the glass to allow the rear wiper blade to be
wiper blade from the wiper arm with the other
2. Position the wiper blade under the hook on raised off of the glass.
hand (move the wiper blade down toward the
base of the wiper arm and away from the J the tip of the wiper arm with the wiper locking NOTE:
hook in the end of the wiper arm). tab open. The rear wiper arm cannot be fully raised off the
3. Insert the receiver bracket on the wiper glass unless the wiper arm pivot cap is unsnapped
assembly into the hook on the tip of the arm first. Attempting to fully raise the rear wiper arm
through the opening in the wiper blade under without unsnapping the wiper arm pivot cap may
the locking tab. damage the vehicle.
4. Slide the wiper blade up into the hook on the
wiper arm until it is latched (engagement will
be accompanied by an audible click). Fold
down the latch release tab and snap it into its
locked position.
5. Gently lower the wiper blade onto the glass.
Removing Wiper From Wiper Arm
1 — Wiper
2 — Locking Tab 8
3 — Wiper Arm J Hook Wiper Pivot Cap In Unlocked Position
1 — Wiper Arm Pivot Cap
6. Gently lower the wiper arm onto the glass. 2 — Wiper Arm
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 278
2. Lift the rear wiper arm fully off the glass. 4. Still holding the bottom end of the wiper blade, NOTE:
move the wiper blade upward and away from The rear wiper arm cannot be fully raised off the
the wiper arm to disengage. glass unless the wiper arm pivot cap is unsnapped
first. Attempting to fully raise the rear wiper arm
without unsnapping the wiper arm pivot cap may
damage the vehicle.
2. Lift the rear wiper arm fully off the glass.
3. Insert the wiper blade pivot pin into the
opening on the end of the wiper arm. Grab the
bottom end of the wiper arm with one hand,
and press the wiper blade flush with the wiper
arm until it snaps into place.
Wiper Blade In Folded Out Position
4. Lower the wiper blade onto the glass and snap
1 — Wiper Blade the wiper arm pivot cap back into place.
Wiper Blade Removed From Wiper Arm
2 — Wiper Arm
3 — Wiper Arm Pivot Cap 1 — Wiper Blade EXHAUST SYSTEM
2 — Wiper Blade Pivot Pin
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry
3. To remove the wiper blade from the wiper arm, 3 — Wiper Arm Receptacle
into the vehicle body is a properly maintained
grab the bottom end of the wiper blade 4 — Wiper Arm engine exhaust system.
nearest to wiper arm with your right hand. With If you notice a change in the sound of the exhaust
your left hand, hold the wiper arm as you pull 5. Gently lower the tip of the wiper arm onto the system; or if the exhaust fumes can be detected
the wiper blade away from the wiper arm past glass. inside the vehicle; or when the underside or rear of
its stop far enough to unsnap the wiper blade the vehicle is damaged; have an authorized
pivot pin from the receptacle on the end of the Installing The Rear Wiper technician inspect the complete exhaust system
wiper arm. 1. Lift the rear wiper arm pivot cap away from and adjacent body areas for broken, damaged,
NOTE: the glass to allow the rear wiper blade to be deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open seams
Resistance will be accompanied by an audible raised off of the glass. or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes
snap. to seep into the passenger compartment.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 279
In addition, have the exhaust system inspected To minimize the possibility of catalytic converter
each time the vehicle is raised for lubrication or oil CAUTION! damage:
change. Replace as required. Damage to the catalytic converter can result if Do not interrupt the ignition when the transmis-
your vehicle is not kept in proper operating sion is in gear and the vehicle is in motion.
WARNING! condition. In the event of engine malfunction,
Do not try to start the vehicle by pushing or
Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain particularly involving engine misfire or other
towing the vehicle.
Carbon Monoxide (CO), which is colorless and apparent loss of performance, have your
vehicle serviced promptly. Continued opera- Do not idle the engine with any ignition compo-
odorless. Breathing it can make you uncon-
tion of your vehicle with a severe malfunction nents disconnected or removed, such as when
scious and can eventually poison you
could cause the converter to overheat, diagnostic testing, or for prolonged periods
Ú page 240.
resulting in possible damage to the converter during very rough idle or malfunctioning oper-
A hot exhaust system can start a fire if you and vehicle. ating conditions.
park over materials that can burn, such mate-
rials might be grass or leaves, and those items COOLING SYSTEM
that come into contact with your exhaust Under normal operating conditions, the catalytic
system. Do not park or operate your vehicle in converter will not require maintenance. However, it WARNING!
areas where your exhaust system can contact is important to keep the engine properly tuned to
ensure proper catalyst operation and prevent You or others can be badly burned by hot
anything that can burn. engine coolant (antifreeze) or steam from your
possible catalyst damage.
radiator. If you see or hear steam coming from
NOTE: under the hood, do not open the hood until the
CAUTION! Intentional tampering with emissions control radiator has had time to cool. Never open a
systems can result in civil penalties being 8
The catalytic converter requires the use of cooling system pressure cap when the radi-
assessed against you. ator or coolant bottle is hot.
unleaded fuel only. Leaded gasoline will
destroy the effectiveness of the catalyst as an In unusual situations involving grossly
malfunctioning engine operation, a scorching odor Keep hands, tools, clothing, and jewelry away
emissions control device and may seriously from the radiator cooling fan when the hood is
reduce engine performance and cause may suggest severe and abnormal catalyst
overheating. If this occurs, stop the vehicle, turn off raised. The fan starts automatically and may
serious damage to the engine. start at any time, whether the engine is
the engine and allow it to cool. Service, including a
(Continued) tune-up to manufacturer specifications, should be running or not.
obtained immediately. (Continued)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 280
Refer to the Maintenance Plan for the proper properly could lead to severe internal engine
WARNING! maintenance intervals Ú page 268. damage. If any coolant is needed to be added to
When working near the radiator cooling fan, the system please contact an authorized dealer.
Selection Of Coolant
disconnect the fan motor lead or turn the igni- Adding Coolant
tion to the OFF mode. The fan is temperature For further information Ú page 323.
controlled and can start at any time the igni- NOTE: Your vehicle has been built with an improved
tion is in the ON mode. engine coolant (OAT coolant conforming to
Mixing of engine coolant (antifreeze) other than
MS.90032) that allows extended maintenance
specified Organic Additive Technology (OAT) intervals. This engine coolant (antifreeze)
Coolant Checks engine coolant, may result in engine damage can be used up to 10 years or 150,000 miles
and may decrease corrosion protection. OAT (240,000 km) before replacement. To prevent
Check engine coolant (antifreeze) protection every engine coolant is different and should not be
12 months (before the onset of freezing weather, reducing this extended maintenance period, it is
mixed with Hybrid Organic Additive Technology important that you use the same engine coolant
where applicable). If the engine coolant is dirty or (HOAT) engine coolant or any “globally compat-
rusty in appearance, the system should be (OAT coolant conforming to MS.90032) throughout
ible” coolant. If a non-OAT engine coolant is the life of your vehicle.
drained, flushed and refilled with fresh engine introduced into the cooling system in an emer-
coolant. Check the front of the A/C condenser for gency, the cooling system will need to be Please review these recommendations for using
any accumulation of bugs, leaves, etc. If dirty, drained, flushed, and refilled with fresh OAT OAT engine coolant that meets the requirements of
clean by gently spraying water from a garden hose coolant (conforming to MS.90032), by an autho- the manufacturer Material Standard MS.90032.
vertically down the face of the condenser. rized dealer as soon as possible. When adding engine coolant:
Cooling System — Drain, Flush And Refill Do not use water alone or alcohol-based engine We recommend using Mopar® Antifreeze/
Some vehicles require special tools to add coolant coolant products. Do not use additional rust Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile (240,000 km)
properly. Failure to fill these systems properly inhibitors or anti-rust products, as they may not Formula OAT that meets the requirements of the
could lead to severe internal engine damage. If any be compatible with the radiator engine coolant manufacturer Material Standard MS.90032.
coolant is needed to be added to the system and may plug the radiator. Mix a minimum solution of 50% OAT engine
please contact an authorized dealer. This vehicle has not been designed for use with coolant that meets the requirements of the
If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or propylene glycol-based engine coolant. Use of manufacturer Material Standard MS.90032
contains visible sediment, have an authorized propylene glycol-based engine coolant is not and distilled water. Use higher concentrations
dealer clean and flush with OAT coolant recommended. (not to exceed 70%) if temperatures below
(conforming to MS.90032). −34°F (−37°C) are anticipated. Please contact
Some vehicles require special tools to add
an authorized dealer for assistance.
coolant properly. Failure to fill these systems
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 281
Use only high purity water such as distilled or The cap should be inspected and cleaned if there Coolant Level
deionized water when mixing the water/engine is any accumulation of foreign material on the
The coolant expansion bottle provides a quick
coolant solution. The use of lower quality water sealing surfaces.
visual method for determining that the coolant
will reduce the amount of corrosion protection
level is adequate. With the engine off and cold, the
in the engine cooling system. WARNING!
level of the engine coolant (antifreeze) in the bottle
NOTE: Do not open hot engine cooling system. Never should be between the “MIN” and “MAX” marks.
It is the owner's responsibility to maintain the add engine coolant (antifreeze) when the As long as the engine operating temperature is
proper level of protection against freezing engine is overheated. Do not loosen or satisfactory, the coolant bottle need only be
according to the temperatures occurring in the remove the cap to cool an overheated engine. checked once a month.
area where the vehicle is operated. Heat causes pressure to build-up in the
cooling system. To prevent scalding or injury, When additional engine coolant is needed to
Some vehicles require special tools to add maintain the proper level, it should be added to the
do not remove the pressure cap while the
coolant properly. Failure to fill these systems coolant bottle. Do not overfill.
system is hot or under pressure.
properly could lead to severe internal engine
damage. If any coolant is needed to be added to Do not use a pressure cap other than the one
Cooling System Notes
the system, please contact an authorized specified for your vehicle. Personal injury or NOTE:
dealer. engine damage may result. When the vehicle is stopped after a few miles/
Mixing engine coolant types is not recom- kilometers of operation, you may observe vapor
mended and can result in cooling system coming from the front of the engine compartment.
Disposal Of Used Coolant
damage. If HOAT and OAT coolant are mixed in This is normally a result of moisture from rain,
Used ethylene glycol-based coolant (antifreeze) is snow, or high humidity accumulating on the
an emergency, have a authorized dealer drain, 8
a regulated substance requiring proper disposal. radiator and being vaporized when the thermostat
flush, and refill with OAT coolant (conforming to
Check with your local authorities to determine the opens, allowing hot engine coolant (antifreeze) to
MS.90032) as soon as possible.
disposal rules for your community. To prevent enter the radiator.
Cooling System Pressure Cap ingestion by animals or children, do not store If an examination of your engine compartment
The cap must be fully tightened to prevent loss of ethylene glycol-based coolant in open containers shows no evidence of radiator or hose leaks, the
engine coolant (antifreeze), and to ensure that engine or allow it to remain in puddles on the ground. vehicle may be safely driven. The vapor will soon
coolant will return to the radiator from the coolant If ingested by a child or pet, seek emergency dissipate.
expansion bottle/recovery tank (if equipped). assistance immediately. Clean up any ground spills
immediately.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 282
Do not overfill the coolant expansion bottle. BRAKE SYSTEM Use only the manufacturer recommended brake
Check the coolant freeze point in the radiator fluid Ú page 324.
In order to ensure brake system performance, all
and in the coolant expansion bottle. If engine
brake system components should be inspected WARNING!
coolant needs to be added, the contents of the
periodically. For the proper maintenance intervals
coolant expansion bottle must also be protected Use only the manufacturer recommended
Ú page 268.
against freezing. brake fluid Ú page 324. Using the wrong type
If frequent engine coolant additions are WARNING! of brake fluid can severely damage your brake
required, the cooling system should be pressure system and/or impair its performance. The
tested for leaks. Riding the brakes can lead to brake failure and proper type of brake fluid for your vehicle is
possibly a collision. Driving with your foot resting or also identified on the original factory installed
Maintain engine coolant concentration at a riding on the brake pedal can result in abnormally hydraulic master cylinder reservoir.
minimum of 50% OAT coolant (conforming to high brake temperatures, excessive lining wear,
MS.90032) and distilled water for proper corro- and possible brake damage. You would not have To avoid contamination from foreign matter or
sion protection of your engine which contains your full braking capacity in an emergency. moisture, use only new brake fluid or fluid that
aluminum components. has been in a tightly closed container. Keep
Make sure that the coolant expansion bottle
the master cylinder reservoir cap secured at
Brake Master Cylinder all times. Brake fluid in a open container
overflow hoses are not kinked or obstructed.
The fluid in the master cylinder should be checked absorbs moisture from the air resulting in a
Keep the front of the radiator clean. If your lower boiling point. This may cause it to boil
when performing under hood services or
vehicle is equipped with air conditioning, keep unexpectedly during hard or prolonged
immediately if the Brake Warning Light is
the front of the condenser clean. braking, resulting in sudden brake failure.
illuminated.
Do not change the thermostat for Summer or This could result in a collision.
Be sure to clean the top of the master cylinder area
Winter operation. If replacement is ever neces-
before removing the cap. If necessary, add fluid to Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result
sary, install ONLY the correct type thermostat.
bring the fluid level up to the requirements in spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts,
Other designs may result in unsatisfactory
described on the brake fluid reservoir. With disc causing the brake fluid to catch fire. Brake
engine cooling performance, poor gas mileage,
brakes, fluid level can be expected to fall as the fluid can also damage painted and vinyl
and increased emissions.
brake pads wear. Brake fluid level should be surfaces, care should be taken to avoid its
checked when pads are replaced. However, low contact with these surfaces.
fluid level may be caused by a leak and a checkup (Continued)
may be needed.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 283
FUSES WARNING!
General Information If a general protection fuse for safety systems
(air bag system, braking system), power unit
WARNING! systems (engine system, transmission
When replacing a blown fuse, always use an system) or steering system blows, contact an
appropriate replacement fuse with the same authorized dealer.
amp rating as the original fuse. Never replace
a fuse with another fuse of higher amp rating. The fuses protect electrical systems against
Never replace a blown fuse with metal wires or excessive current.
any other material. Do not place a fuse inside Blade Fuses
When a device does not work, you must check the
a circuit breaker cavity or vice versa. Failure to
fuse element inside the blade fuse for a break/ 1 — Fuse Element
use proper fuses may result in serious
melt. 2 — Blade Fuse with a good/functional fuse
personal injury, fire and/or property damage.
Also, please be aware that using power outlets for element
Before replacing a fuse, make sure that the extended periods of time with the engine off may 3 — Blade fuse with a bad/not functional fuse
ignition is off and that all the other services result in vehicle battery discharge. element (blown fuse)
are switched off and/or disengaged.
If the replaced fuse blows again, contact an
authorized dealer. Fuse Location
(Continued) The fuses are grouped into controllers located in
the engine compartment.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 285
25 Amp Clear
F27 – Engine Control Module (ECM) / Fuel Injectors
20 Amp Yellow
F28 – – –
F29A & B – – –
F30 – 20 Amp Yellow RT HID Lamp
F31 – 15 Amp Blue Wireless Charging Pad / SW Bank Lower 2 / SW Bank Lower LT & RT
20 Amp Yellow (Gas) Fuel Injectors / Ignition Coils / Ignition Coil Capacitors (Gas Engine) 8
F32 – UEGO (02) Sensor – Upstream & Downstream / Glow Plug Module / Oil Pump /
15 Amp Blue (Diesel) Mass Airflow Sensor / EGR Cooling Bypass / Swirl Actuator / SNSR UEGO DSL Upstream /
Pump UREA Cooling (Diesel Engine)
F33 – 10 Amp Red Relay Coil Power Control Relay 2.4 Dual battery application only (XHZ)
F34A & B – – –
F35 – – –
F36 – 10 Amp Red Port UCI2 / Mod CVPM
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 288
8
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 290
Interior Fuses
The interior fuse panel is located in the passenger compartment on the left side dash panel under the instrument panel.
BULB R EPLACEMENT
Replacement Bulbs, Names, And Part Numbers
In the instance a bulb needs to be replaced, this section includes bulb description and replacement part numbers.
NOTE:
See an authorized dealer for LED bulb replacement.
Interior Bulbs
Lamps Bulb Number
Front Courtesy Light C5W
Front Courtesy Lights (Sun Visors) C5W
Rear Dome Light (Models Without Retractable roof) C5W
Rear Interior Lights (Models With Retractable roof) C5W
Interior Lights HT-168
Dome Light (Glove Box) HT-168
8
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 292
Exterior Bulbs
Lamps Bulb Number
Low Beam Headlamps LED (Serviced at an authorized dealer)
High Beam Headlamps LED (Serviced at an authorized dealer)
Front Position/Daytime Running Lights (DRL)/Front Directional - Premium LED (Serviced at an authorized dealer)
Front Direction Indicator & Position Lamps - Base 7442NA
Side Marker Lamp Base:2825
Front Fog Lamps Base: H11LL/ Premium LED
Side Indicators (Side View Mirror) LED (Serviced at an authorized dealer)
Premium Tail Lights: LED (Serviced at an authorized dealer)
Tail/Brake Lights
Base Tail Lights: W21/5WLL
W21WLL For Premium Tail Lamps
Turn Indicators
W21/5WLL For Base Tail Lamps
Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL) LED (Serviced at an authorized dealer)
License Plate Lamp LED (Serviced at an authorized dealer)
Liftgate Lamp Reverse W21WLL
Liftgate Lamp Tail LED (Serviced at an authorized dealer)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 293
3. Disconnect the electrical connector by pushing 5. Replace the bulb as necessary by turning and 9. Reinstall the body side lamp making sure to
the release. removing the bulb housing. align the ball studs.
4. Remove the rear body side tail lamp, sliding it
away from the back of the vehicle.
Reverse Lamps 3rd Stop Lamp 2. Release the retainer clips and bulb housing as
1. Open the liftgate. The CHMSL is LED. See an authorized dealer for shown.
2. Using a suitable tool remove the access panel replacement.
for body side lamps, remove liftgate access License Plate Lights
cover for liftgate lamps. The License Plate light is LED. See an authorized
dealer for replacement.
Replacing Interior Bulbs
Front Courtesy Light
To replace the bulbs proceed as follows:
1. Using a suitable tool remove the front
courtesy light assembly.
Front Courtesy Bulb Housing
1 — Retaining Clips
2 — Bulb Housing
Liftgate
1 — Liftgate Access Covers
3. Replace the bulbs by pulling straight out of Dome Light Vanity Mirror — If Equipped Dome Light Glove Compartment
bulb housing. To replace the bulbs proceed as follows: To replace the bulb proceed as follows:
1. Lift the cover of the mirror and pull out the 1. Open the glove compartment.
mirror frame with the mirror light cover 2. Place your fingers inside the light assembly,
attached. pull the bulb to replace it.
2. Replace the bulb, releasing it from the side
contacts, and then insert the new bulb, making
sure that it is properly locked between the
contacts.
Dome Light 3. Insert the new bulb, locking it between the 2. Fully disengage the bulb holder from the
To replace the bulbs proceed as follows: contacts. housing.
1. Lower the handle in the direction shown; 4. Reinstall the dome light.
remove the dome light.
Interior Cargo Lights
To replace the bulbs proceed as follows:
1. Using thumb with slight pressure – push bulb
holder to the side.
Bulb Holder
3. Rotate bulb holder to replace bulb.
Grab Handle/Dome Light
2. Replace the bulb by removing it from the side
contacts.
Bulb Holder
8
Bulb
Bulb
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 298
EXAMPLE:
Example Size Designation: P215/65R15XL 95H, 215/65R15 96H, LT235/85R16C, T145/80D18 103M, 31x10.5 R15 LT
P = Passenger car tire size based on US design standards, or
"....blank...." = Passenger car tire based on European design standards, or
LT = Light truck tire based on US design standards, or
T or S = Temporary spare tire or
31 = Overall diameter in inches (in)
215, 235, 145 = Section width in millimeters (mm)
65, 85, 80 = Aspect ratio in percent (%)
Ratio of section height to section width of tire, or
10.5 = Section width in inches (in)
R = Construction code
"R" means radial construction, or
"D" means diagonal or bias construction
15, 16, 18 = Rim diameter in inches (in) 8
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 300
EXAMPLE:
Service Description:
95 = Load Index
A numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can carry
H = Speed Symbol
A symbol indicating the range of speeds at which a tire can carry a load corresponding to its load index under certain operating conditions
The maximum speed corresponding to the speed symbol should only be achieved under specified operating conditions (i.e., tire pressure, vehicle loading,
road conditions, and posted speed limits)
Load Identification:
Absence of the following load identification symbols on the sidewall of the tire indicates a Standard Load (SL) tire:
XL = Extra load (or reinforced) tire, or
LL = Light load tire or
C, D, E, F, G = Load range associated with the maximum load a tire can carry at a specified pressure
Maximum Load – Maximum load indicates the maximum load this tire is designed to carry
Maximum Pressure – Maximum pressure indicates the maximum permissible cold tire inflation pressure for this tire
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 301
EXAMPLE:
DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301
DOT = Department of Transportation
This symbol certifies that the tire is in compliance with the US Department of Transportation tire safety standards and is approved for highway use
MA = Code representing the tire manufacturing location (two digits)
L9 = Code representing the tire size (two digits)
ABCD = Code used by the tire manufacturer (one to four digits)
03 = Number representing the week in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
03 means the 3rd week
01 = Number representing the year in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
01 means the year 2001
Prior to July 2000, tire manufacturers were only required to have one number to represent the year in which the tire was manufactured.
Example: 031 could represent the 3rd week of 1981 or 1991 8
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 302
Tire Loading And Tire Pressure 3. Tire size designed for your vehicle.
NOTE: 4. Cold tire inflation pressures for the front, rear,
The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on and spare tires.
the driver’s side B-pillar or the rear edge of the
driver's side door. LOADING
Check the inflation pressure of each tire, including The vehicle maximum load on the tire must not
the spare tire (if equipped), at least monthly and exceed the load carrying capacity of the tire on your
inflate to the recommended pressure for your vehicle. You will not exceed the tire's load carrying
vehicle. capacity if you adhere to the loading conditions,
tire size, and cold tire inflation pressures specified
Example Tire Placard Location (B-pillar) on the Tire and Loading Information placard
Tire And Loading Information Placard Ú page 153.
NOTE:
Under a maximum loaded vehicle condition, Gross
Axle Weight Ratings (GAWRs) for the front and rear
axles must not be exceeded Ú page 153.
To determine the maximum loading conditions of
your vehicle, locate the statement “The combined
weight of occupants and cargo should never
exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs” on the Tire and Loading
Example Tire Placard Location (Door) Information placard. The combined weight of
8
occupants, cargo/luggage and trailer tongue
weight (if applicable) should never exceed the
Tire And Loading Information Placard weight referenced here.
This placard tells you important information
about the:
1. Number of people that can be carried in the
vehicle.
2. Total weight your vehicle can carry.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 304
Steps For Determining Correct Load (5) Determine the combined weight of Metric Example For Load Limit
Limit— luggage and cargo being loaded on the For example, if “XXX” amount equals 635 kg and
(1) Locate the statement “The combined vehicle. That weight may not safely there will be five 68 kg passengers in your vehicle,
exceed the available cargo and luggage the amount of available cargo and luggage load
weight of occupants and cargo should capacity is 295 kg (635-340 (5x68) = 295 kg) as
never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.” on your load capacity calculated in Step 4.
shown in step 4.
vehicle's placard. (6) If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, NOTE:
(2) Determine the combined weight of load from your trailer will be transferred If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from
the driver and passengers that will be to your vehicle. Consult this manual to your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle.
riding in your vehicle. determine how this reduces the The following table shows examples on how to
available cargo and luggage load calculate total load, cargo/luggage, and towing
(3) Subtract the combined weight of the
capacity of your vehicle. capacities of your vehicle with varying seating
driver and passengers from XXX kg or configurations and number and size of occu-
XXX lbs. pants. This table is for illustration purposes only
(4) The resulting figure equals the and may not be accurate for the seating and
load carry capacity of your vehicle.
available amount of cargo and luggage
For the following example, the combined weight
load capacity. For example, if “XXX”
of occupants and cargo should never exceed
amount equals 1400 lbs. and there will 865 lbs (392 kg).
be five 150 lb passengers in your
vehicle, the amount of available cargo
and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs.
(1400-750 (5x150) = 650 lbs.)
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 305
WARNING!
Overloading of your tires is dangerous. Overloading can cause tire failure, affect vehicle handling, and increase your stopping distance. Use tires of the
recommended load capacity for your vehicle. Never overload them.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 306
Inflation pressures specified on the placard are Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation Tire Repair
always “cold tire inflation pressure”. Cold tire If your tire becomes damaged, it may be repaired if
The manufacturer advocates driving at safe
inflation pressure is defined as the tire pressure it meets the following criteria:
speeds and within posted speed limits. Where
after the vehicle has not been driven for at least
speed limits or conditions are such that the vehicle The tire has not been driven on when flat.
three hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km)
can be driven at high speeds, maintaining correct
after sitting for a minimum of three hours. The cold The damage is only on the tread section of your
tire inflation pressure is very important. Increased
tire inflation pressure must not exceed the tire (sidewall damage is not repairable).
tire pressure and reduced vehicle loading may be
maximum inflation pressure molded into the tire The puncture is no greater than ¼ of an
required for high-speed vehicle operation. Refer to
sidewall. inch (6 mm).
an authorized tire dealer or original equipment
Check tire pressures more often if subject to a vehicle dealer for recommended safe operating Consult an authorized tire dealer for tire repairs
wide range of outdoor temperatures, as tire speeds, loading and cold tire inflation pressures. and additional information.
pressures vary with temperature changes.
Damaged Run Flat tires, or Run Flat tires that have
Tire pressures change by approximately 1 psi WARNING!
experienced a loss of pressure should be replaced
(7 kPa) per 12°F (7°C) of air temperature change. High speed driving with your vehicle under immediately with another Run Flat tire of identical
Keep this in mind when checking tire pressure maximum load is dangerous. The added strain size and service description (Load Index and
inside a garage, especially in the Winter. on your tires could cause them to fail. You could Speed Symbol). Replace the tire pressure sensor
Example: If garage temperature = 68°F (20°C) have a serious collision. Do not drive a vehicle as well as it is not designed to be reused.
and the outside temperature = 32°F (0°C) then loaded to the maximum capacity at continuous
Run Flat Tires — If Equipped
the cold tire inflation pressure should be increased speeds above 75 mph (120 km/h).
by 3 psi (21 kPa), which equals 1 psi (7 kPa) for Run Flat tires allow you the capability to drive
every 12°F (7°C) for this outside temperature 50 miles (80 km) at 50 mph (80 km/h) after a 8
Radial Ply Tires rapid loss of inflation pressure. This rapid loss of
condition.
inflation is referred to as the Run Flat mode. A Run
Tire pressure may increase from 2 to 6 psi (13 to WARNING! Flat mode occurs when the tire inflation pressure
40 kPa) during operation. DO NOT reduce this is/or below 14 psi (96 kPa). Once a Run Flat tire
Combining radial ply tires with other types of tires
normal pressure build-up or your tire pressure will reaches the Run Flat mode it has limited driving
on your vehicle will cause your vehicle to handle
be too low. capabilities and needs to be replaced immediately.
poorly. The instability could cause a collision.
Always use radial ply tires in sets of four. A Run Flat tire is not repairable. When a Run Flat
Never combine them with other types of tires. tire is changed after driving with an underinflated
tire condition, please replace the TPMS sensor as
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 308
it is not designed to be reused when driven under Tread Wear Indicators Life Of Tire
a Run Flat mode 14 psi (96 kPa) condition.
Tread wear indicators are in the original equipment The service life of a tire is dependent upon varying
NOTE: tires to help you in determining when your tires factors including, but not limited to:
TPMS sensor must be replaced after driving the should be replaced. Driving style.
vehicle on a flat tire condition.
Tire pressure - Improper cold tire inflation pres-
It is not recommended to drive a vehicle loaded at
sures can cause uneven wear patterns to
full capacity or to tow a trailer while a tire is in the
develop across the tire tread. These abnormal
Run Flat mode.
wear patterns will reduce tread life, resulting in
For more information Ú page 201. the need for earlier tire replacement.
Tire Spinning Distance driven.
When stuck in mud, sand, snow, or ice conditions, Performance tires, tires with a speed rating of
do not spin your vehicle's wheels above 30 mph V or higher, and Summer tires typically have a
(48 km/h) or for longer than 30 seconds reduced tread life. Rotation of these tires per
continuously without stopping Ú page 262. the vehicle scheduled maintenance is highly
Tire Tread recommended.
WARNING!
1 — Worn Tire
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces
WARNING!
2 — New Tire
generated by excessive wheel speeds may Tires and the spare tire should be replaced after
cause tire damage or failure. A tire could six years, regardless of the remaining tread.
explode and injure someone. Do not spin your These indicators are molded into the bottom of the Failure to follow this warning can result in sudden
vehicle's wheels faster than 30 mph (48 km/h) tread grooves. They will appear as bands when the tire failure. You could lose control and have a
for more than 30 seconds continuously when tread depth becomes 1/16 of an inch (1.6 mm). collision resulting in serious injury or death.
you are stuck, and do not let anyone near a When the tread is worn to the tread wear
spinning wheel, no matter what the speed. indicators, the tire should be replaced
Ú page 309. NOTE:
The Wheel Valve Stem must be replaced as well
when installing new tires due to wear and tear in
existing tires.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 309
Summer tires do not contain the all season above 75 mph (120 km/h) refer to original Spare Tire Matching Original Equipped Tire
designation or mountain/snowflake symbol on the equipment or an authorized tire dealer for And Wheel — If Equipped
tire sidewall. Use Summer tires only in sets of four; recommended safe operating speeds, loading and
failure to do so may adversely affect the safety and cold tire inflation pressures. Your vehicle may be equipped with a spare tire and
handling of your vehicle. wheel equivalent in look and function to the
While studded tires improve performance on ice, original equipment tire and wheel found on the
skid and traction capability on wet or dry surfaces front or rear axle of your vehicle. This spare tire
WARNING! may be poorer than that of non-studded tires. may be used in the tire rotation for your vehicle. If
Do not use Summer tires in snow/ice conditions. Some states prohibit studded tires; therefore, local your vehicle has this option, refer to an authorized
You could lose vehicle control, resulting in laws should be checked before using these tire tire dealer for the recommended tire rotation
severe injury or death. Driving too fast for types. pattern.
conditions also creates the possibility of loss of
vehicle control.
SPARE T IRES — IF E QUIPPED Compact Spare Tire — If Equipped
NOTE: The compact spare is for temporary emergency
For vehicles equipped with Tire Service Kit instead use only. You can identify if your vehicle is
Snow Tires equipped with a compact spare by looking at the
of a spare tire Ú page 252.
Some areas of the country require the use of snow spare tire description on the Tire and Loading
tires during the Winter. Snow tires can be identified CAUTION! Information Placard located on the driver’s side
by a mountain/snowflake symbol on the tire door opening or on the sidewall of the tire.
sidewall. Because of the reduced ground clearance, do
Compact spare tire descriptions begin with the
not take your vehicle through an automatic car
If you need snow tires, select tires letter “T” or “S” preceding the size designation.
wash with a compact or limited use temporary
equivalent in size and type to the original Example: T145/80D18 103M.
spare installed. Damage to the vehicle may
equipment tires. Use snow tires only in result. T, S = Temporary Spare Tire
sets of four; failure to do so may Since this tire has limited tread life, the original
adversely affect the safety and handling of equipment tire should be repaired (or replaced)
your vehicle. For restrictions when towing with a spare tire
designated for temporary emergency use and reinstalled on your vehicle at the first
Snow tires generally have lower speed ratings Ú page 157. opportunity.
than what was originally equipped with your Do not install a wheel cover or attempt to mount a
vehicle and should not be operated at sustained conventional tire on the compact spare wheel,
speeds over 75 mph (120 km/h). For speeds since the wheel is designed specifically for the
compact spare tire. Do not install more than one
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 311
compact spare tire and wheel on the vehicle at any Limited Use Spare — If Equipped SNOW TRACTION D EVICES
given time.
The limited use spare tire is for temporary Use of traction devices require sufficient
emergency use only. This tire is identified by a label tire-to-body clearance. Due to limited clearance,
WARNING!
located on the limited use spare wheel. This label the following snow traction devices are
Compact and collapsible spares are for temporary contains the driving limitations for this spare. This recommended. Follow these recommendations to
emergency use only. With these spares, do not tire may look like the original equipped tire on the guard against damage:
drive more than 50 mph (80 km/h). Temporary front or rear axle of your vehicle, but it is not.
use spares have limited tread life. When the tread Installation of this limited use spare tire affects Snow traction device must be of proper size for
is worn to the tread wear indicators, the vehicle handling. Since it is not the same as your the tire, as recommended by the snow traction
temporary use spare tire needs to be replaced. Be original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the device manufacturer.
sure to follow the warnings, which apply to your original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle No other tire sizes are recommended for use
spare. Failure to do so could result in spare tire at the first opportunity. with the snow traction device.
failure and loss of vehicle control. Please follow the table below for the recom-
WARNING! mended tire size, axle and snow traction device:
Full-Size Spare — If Equipped Limited use spares are for emergency use only.
Installation of this limited use spare tire affects
The Full-Size spare is for temporary emergency use
vehicle handling. With this tire, do not drive
only. This tire may look like the originally equipped
more than the speed listed on the limited use
tire on the front or rear axle of your vehicle, but it is
spare wheel. Keep inflated to the cold tire
not. This spare tire may have limited tread life.
inflation pressures listed on your Tire and
When the tread is worn to the tread wear 8
Loading Information Placard located on the
indicators, the temporary use Full-Size spare tire
driver’s side B-pillar or the rear edge of the
needs to be replaced. Since it is not the same as
driver’s side door. Replace (or repair) the original
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the
equipment tire at the first opportunity and
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle
reinstall it on your vehicle. Failure to do so could
at the first opportunity.
result in loss of vehicle control.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 312
WARNING!
Using tires of different size and type (M+S, Snow) between front and rear axles can cause unpredictable handling. You could lose control and have a collision.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 313
When cleaning extremely dirty wheels including Dark Vapor Chrome, Black Satin Chrome, or Low PRESERVING T HE BODYWORK
excessive brake dust, care must be taken in the Gloss Clear Coat Wheels
selection of tire and wheel cleaning chemicals and Washing
equipment to prevent damage to the wheels. CAUTION! Wash your vehicle regularly. Always wash your
Mopar® Wheel Treatment, Mopar® Chrome vehicle in the shade using Mopar® Car Wash, or
If your vehicle is equipped with these specialty
Cleaner or their equivalent is recommended, or a mild car wash soap, and rinse the panels
wheels, DO NOT USE wheel cleaners, abrasives,
select a non-abrasive, non-acidic cleaner for completely with water.
or polishing compounds. They will permanently
aluminum or chrome wheels.
damage this finish and such damage is not If insects, tar, or other similar deposits have
covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. accumulated on your vehicle, use Mopar®
CAUTION!
HAND WASH ONLY USING MILD SOAP AND Super Kleen Bug and Tar Remover to remove.
Do not use scouring pads, steel wool, a bristle WATER WITH A SOFT CLOTH. Used on a regular
Use a high quality cleaner wax, such as Mopar®
brush, metal polishes or oven cleaner. These basis; this is all that is required to maintain this
Cleaner Wax to remove road film, stains and to
products may damage the wheel's protective finish.
protect your paint finish. Use precautions to not
finish. Such damage is not covered by the New scratch the paint.
Vehicle Limited Warranty. Only car wash soap,
Mopar® Wheel Cleaner or equivalent is
Cleaning Headlights Avoid using abrasive compounds and power
recommended. Your vehicle is equipped with plastic headlights buffing that may diminish the gloss or thin out
and fog lights that are lighter and less susceptible the paint finish.
to stone breakage than glass headlights.
NOTE: CAUTION!
If you intend parking or storing your vehicle for an Plastic is not as scratch resistant as glass and
extended period after cleaning the wheels with therefore different lens cleaning procedures must Do not use abrasive or strong cleaning mate-
wheel cleaner, drive your vehicle and apply the be followed. rials such as steel wool or scouring powder
brakes to remove the water droplets from the To minimize the possibility of scratching the lenses that will scratch metal and painted surfaces.
brake components. This activity will remove the and reducing light output, avoid wiping with a dry Use of power washers exceeding 1,200 psi
red rust on the brake rotors and prevent vehicle cloth. To remove road dirt, wash with a mild soap (8,274 kPa) can result in damage or removal
vibration when braking. solution followed by rinsing. of paint and decals.
Do not use abrasive cleaning components,
solvents, steel wool or other aggressive material to
clean the lenses.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 317
319
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) will still function. However, the effort required to
brake the vehicle will be much greater than that
WHEEL AND TIRE TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
The VIN is found on the left front corner of the required with the power system operating. Proper lug nut/bolt torque is very important to
windshield and is visible from the outside of the If either of the two hydraulic systems lose normal ensure that the wheel is properly mounted to the
vehicle. capability, the remaining system will still function vehicle. Any time a wheel has been removed and
with some loss of overall braking effectiveness. reinstalled on the vehicle, the lug nuts/bolts
This will be evident by increased pedal travel should be torqued using a properly calibrated
during application and greater pedal force torque wrench using a six-sided (hex) deep wall
required to slow or stop. In addition, if the socket.
malfunction is caused by an internal leak, as TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
the brake fluid in the master cylinder drops, the
Brake Warning Light will light. Lug Nut/Bolt **Lug Nut/ Lug Nut/Bolt
Torque Bolt Size Socket Size
WARNING!
100 Ft-Lb
M12 x 1.25 19 mm
Driving a vehicle with the Brake Warning Light on (135 N·m)
Vehicle Identification Number is dangerous. A significant decrease in braking
performance or vehicle stability during braking
**Use only authorized dealer recommended lug
NOTE: may occur. It will take you longer to stop the
nuts/bolts and clean or remove any dirt or oil
It is illegal to remove or alter the VIN. vehicle or will make your vehicle harder to
before tightening.
control. You could have a collision. Have the 9
BRAKE SYSTEM vehicle checked immediately. Inspect the wheel mounting surface prior to
mounting the tire and remove any corrosion or
Your vehicle is equipped with power assisted loose particles.
brakes as standard equipment. In the event power
assist is lost for any reason (for example, repeated
brake applications with the engine off), the brakes
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 320
After 25 miles (40 km), check the lug nut/bolt 2.4L E NGINE
torque to be sure that all the lug nuts/bolts are
properly tightened. This engine is designed to meet all
emission regulations and provide
WARNING! excellent fuel economy and performance
when using high quality unleaded regular
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the gasoline having a octane rating of 87 using the
jack, do not tighten the lug nuts/bolts fully until (R+M)/2 method. The use of premium gasoline is
the vehicle has been lowered. Failure to follow not recommended, as it will not provide any benefit
this warning may result in personal injury. over regular gasoline in these engines.
Wheel Mounting Surface REFORMULATED G ASOLINE
Tighten the lug nuts/bolts in a star pattern until
FUEL REQUIREMENTS Many areas of the country require the use of
each nut/bolt has been tightened twice. Ensure While operating on gasoline with the required cleaner-burning gasoline referred to as
that the socket is fully engaged on the lug nut/bolt octane number, hearing a light knocking sound “reformulated gasoline”. Reformulated gasoline
(do not insert it halfway). from the engine is not a cause for concern. contains oxygenates and are specifically blended
However, if the engine is heard making a heavy to reduce vehicle emissions and improve air
knocking sound, see a dealer immediately. Use of quality.
gasoline with a lower than recommended octane
The use of reformulated gasoline is recommended.
number can cause engine failure and may void or
Properly blended reformulated gasoline will
not be covered by the New Vehicle Limited
provide improved performance and durability of
Warranty.
engine and fuel system components.
Torque Patterns
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 321
GASOLINE/OXYGENATE BLENDS E-85 U SAGE I N NON-F LEX FUEL that result from running CNG or LP are not the
responsibility of the manufacturer and may void
Some fuel suppliers blend unleaded gasoline with V EHICLES the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
oxygenates such as ethanol. Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles (FFV) are compatible with
gasoline containing up to 15% ethanol (E-15).
METHYLCYCLOPENTADIENYL
CAUTION! Gasoline with higher ethanol content may void the MANGANESE TRICARBONYL (MMT) I N
DO NOT use E-85, gasoline containing methanol, New Vehicle Limited Warranty. GASOLINE
or gasoline containing more than 15% ethanol If a Non-FFV vehicle is inadvertently fueled with
(E-15). Use of these blends may result in starting MMT is a manganese-containing metallic additive
E-85 fuel, the engine will have some or all of these
and drivability problems, damage critical fuel that is blended into some gasoline to increase
symptoms:
system components, cause emissions to exceed octane. Gasoline blended with MMT provides no
Operate in a lean mode. performance advantage beyond gasoline of the
the applicable standard, and/or cause the
Malfunction Indicator Light to illuminate. Please OBD II Malfunction Indicator Light on. same octane number without MMT. Gasoline
observe pump labels as they should clearly blended with MMT reduces spark plug life and
Poor engine performance.
communicate if a fuel contains greater than reduces emissions system performance in some
Poor cold start and cold drivability. vehicles. The manufacturer recommends that
15% ethanol (E-15).
Increased risk for fuel system component corro- gasoline without MMT be used in your vehicle. The
sion. MMT content of gasoline may not be indicated on
Problems that result from using gasoline the gasoline pump, therefore, you should ask the
containing more than 15% ethanol (E-15) or CNG AND LP F UEL SYSTEM gasoline retailer whether or not his/her gasoline
gasoline containing methanol are not the
responsibility of the manufacturer and may void
MODIFICATIONS contains MMT. MMT is prohibited in Federal and
California reformulated gasoline.
the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. Modifications that allow the engine to run on
Compressed Natural Gas (CNG) or Liquid Propane
(LP) may result in damage to the engine,
9
emissions, and fuel system components. Problems
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 322
FLUID CAPACITIES
US Metric
Fuel (Approximate)
All Engines 13.5 Gallons 51 Liters
Engine Oil With Filter
2.4L Engine 5.5 Quarts 5.2 Liters
Cooling System*
2.4L Engine 6.8 Quarts 6.5 Liters
* Includes heater and coolant recovery bottle filled to MAX level.
325
CUSTOMER ASSISTANCE
SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE Any communication to FCA US LLC’s customer
center should include the following information:
FOR YOUR VEHICLE FCA US LLC and its authorized dealers are vitally Owner's name and address
interested in your satisfaction. We want you to be
Owner's telephone number
PREPARE F OR T HE APPOINTMENT happy with our products and services.
(home, mobile, and office)
All work to be performed may not be covered by the Warranty service must be done by an authorized
dealer. We strongly recommend that you take the Authorized dealer name
warranty. Discuss additional charges with the
service manager. Keep a maintenance log of your vehicle to an authorized dealer. They know your Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
vehicle's service history. This can often provide a vehicle the best, and are most concerned that you Vehicle delivery date and mileage
clue to the current problem. get prompt and high quality service. FCA US LLC’s
authorized dealers have the facilities, FCA US LLC CUSTOMER CENTER
PREPARE A L IST factory-trained technicians, special tools, and the
latest information to ensure the vehicle is fixed P.O. Box 21–8004
Make a written list of your vehicle's problems or the correctly and in a timely manner. Auburn Hills, MI 48321–8004
specific work you want done. If you've had an
accident or work done that is not on your This is why you should always talk to an authorized Phone: (877) 426-5337
dealer’s service manager first. If for some reason
maintenance log, let the service advisor know.
you are still not satisfied, talk to the general
FCA C ANADA INC. C USTOMER CENTER
BE R EASONABLE WITH REQUESTS manager or owner of the authorized dealer. P.O. Box 1621
They want to know if you need assistance. If an
If you list a number of items and you must have Windsor, Ontario N9A 4H6
authorized dealer is unable to resolve the concern,
your vehicle by the end of the day, discuss the Phone: (800) 465-2001 English /
you may contact FCA US LLC's Customer
situation with the service advisor and list the items (800) 387-9983 French
Assistance center.
in order of priority. At many authorized dealers, you 10
may obtain a rental vehicle (additional charges
may apply). If you need a rental, it is advisable to
make these arrangements when you call for an
appointment.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 326
MEXICO Canadian residents with hearing difficulties that FCA US LLC is not responsible for any service
require assistance can use the special needs relay contract you may have purchased from another
Av. Prolongacion Paseo de la Reforma, 1240 service offered by Bell Canada. For TTY manufacturer. If you require service after the
Sante Fe C.P. 05109 teletypewriter users, dial 711 and for Voice callers, FCA US LLC New Vehicle Limited Warranty expires,
dial 1-800-855-0511 to connect with a Bell Relay please refer to the contract documents, and
Mexico, D. F.
Service operator. contact the person listed in those documents.
In Mexico City: (800) 505-1300
SERVICE CONTRACT We appreciate that you have made a major
Outside Mexico City: +(52) 55 50817568 investment when you purchased the vehicle.
You may have purchased a service contract for a An authorized dealer has also made a major
PUERTO R ICO AND US VIRGIN ISLANDS vehicle to help protect you from the high cost of investment in facilities, tools, and training to
FCA Caribbean LLC unexpected repairs after FCA US LLC's New Vehicle assure that you are absolutely delighted with the
P.O. Box 191857 Limited Warranty expires. The Mopar® Vehicle ownership experience.
Protection plans are the ONLY vehicle extended
San Juan, Puerto Rico, 00919-1857 protection plans authorized, endorsed and backed WARNING!
Phone: (877) 426-5337 by FCA US LLC to provide additional protection
Engine exhaust (internal combustion engines
Fax: (787) 782-3345 beyond your vehicle’s warranty. If you purchased a
only), some of its constituents, and certain
Mopar® Vehicle Protection Plan, you will receive
vehicle components contain, or emit, chemicals
C USTOMER A SSISTANCE F OR T HE Plan Provisions and an Owner Identification Card in
known to the State of California to cause cancer
H EARING O R S PEECH IMPAIRED the mail within three weeks of the vehicle delivery
and birth defects, or other reproductive harm. In
date. If you have any questions about the service
(TDD/TTY) contract, call FCA US LLC’s Service Contract
addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and
certain products of component wear contain, or
To assist customers who have hearing difficulties, National Customer Hotline at 1-800-521-9922
emit, chemicals known to the State of California
FCA US LLC has installed special Telecommu- (Canadian residents, call (800) 465-2001
to cause cancer and birth defects, or other
nication Devices for the Deaf (TDD) equipment at English / (800) 387-9983 French).
reproductive harm.
its customer center. Any hearing or speech
impaired customer, who has access to a TDD or a
conventional teletypewriter (TTY) in the United
States, can communicate with FCA US LLC by
dialing 1-800-380-2479.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 327
WARRANTY INFORMATION REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS D.C. 20590. You can also obtain other
information about motor vehicle safety
See the Warranty Information for the terms and
provisions of FCA US LLC warranties applicable to
I N T HE 50 U NITED STATES AND from http://www.safercar.gov.
this vehicle and market. Refer to WASHINGTON, D.C. I N C ANADA
www.mopar.com/om for further information.
If you believe that your vehicle has a If you believe that your vehicle has a
See the Warranty Information for the terms and defect that could cause a crash or cause
provisions of FCA Canada Inc. warranties safety defect, you should contact the
injury or death, you should immediately Customer Service Department
applicable to this vehicle and market. Refer to
www.owners.mopar.ca/en/ for further inform the National Highway Traffic immediately. Canadian customers who
information. Safety Administration (NHTSA) in wish to report a safety defect to the
Use this QR code to access your
addition to notifying FCA US LLC. Canadian government should contact
digital experience. If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it Transport Canada, Motor Vehicle Defect
may open an investigation, and if it finds Investigations and Recalls at
that a safety defect exists in a group of 1-800-333-0510 or go to
vehicles, it may order a recall and wwwapps.tc.gc.ca/Saf-Sec-Sur/7/
remedy campaign. However, NHTSA PCDB-BDPP.
MOPAR® PARTS cannot become involved in individual
Mopar® original equipment parts & accessories problems between you, an authorized PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS
and factory filled fluids are available from an dealer, or FCA US LLC. To order the following manuals, you may use either
authorized dealer. They are recommended for your
vehicle to keep it operating at its best and maintain
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle the website or the phone numbers listed below.
its original condition. Safety Hotline toll free at 1-888-327-4236 Service Manuals
(TTY: 1-800-424-9153); or go to These comprehensive Service Manuals provide a
http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: complete working knowledge of the vehicle, 10
Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey system, and/or components and is written in
Avenue, SE., West Building, Washington, straightforward language with illustrations,
diagrams, and charts.
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 328
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals GENERAL INFORMATION La operación de este equipo está sujeta a las
siguientes dos condiciones:
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals are filled with
diagrams, charts and detailed illustrations. These The following regulatory statement applies to all 1. es posible que este equipo o dispositivo no
manuals make it easy to find and fix problems on Radio Frequency (RF) devices equipped in this cause interferencia perjudicial y
computer-controlled vehicle systems and features. vehicle:
2. este equipo o dispositivo debe aceptar
They show exactly how to find and correct This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules cualquier interferencia, incluyendo la que
problems, using step-by-step troubleshooting and and with Innovation, Science and Economic pueda causar su operación no deseada.
drivability procedures, proven diagnostic tests and Development Canada license-exempt RSS
a complete list of all tools and equipment. standard(s). Operation is subject to the following NOTE:
To order a hard copy of your Service or Diagnostic two conditions: Changes or modifications not expressly approved
Procedure manuals, visit: 1. This device may not cause harmful by the party responsible for compliance could void
interference, and the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
www.techauthority.com (US and Canada).
2. This device must accept any interference
Owner's Manuals
received, including interference that may
These Owner's Manuals have been prepared with cause undesired operation.
the assistance of service and engineering
specialists to acquaint you with specific FCA Le présent appareil est conforme aux CNR
vehicles. d`Innovation, Science and Economic Development
To access your Owner's Information online, visit applicables aux appareils radio exempts de
www.mopar.com/om (US) or licence. L'exploitation est autorisée aux deux
www.owners.mopar.ca (Canada). conditions suivantes:
329
INDEX
A Air Conditioning, Operating Tips .......................56 Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) ..............56
Active Lane Management System .................145 Air Filter ........................................................ 274 Automatic Transaxle ..................................... 106
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)........................116 Air Pressure Automatic Transmission................................ 107
Adding Engine Coolant (Antifreeze) ...............280 Tires ......................................................... 306 Adding Fluid ..................................... 283, 324
Additives, Fuel ...............................................322 Alarm Fluid And Filter Change............................. 283
Air Bag ...........................................................214 Arm The System ..........................................21 Fluid Change............................................. 283
Air Bag Operation ......................................215 Disarm The System .....................................22 Fluid Level Check...................................... 283
Air Bag Warning Light ...................... 213, 216 Security Alarm ...................................... 21, 92 Fluid Type ........................................ 283, 324
Driver Knee Air Bag ...................................219 Alarm System Special Additives ...................................... 283
Enhanced Accident Response ......... 224, 266 Security Alarm .............................................21 Automatic Transmission Limp Home Mode......25
Event Data Recorder (EDR) .......................266 Alterations/Modifications Auxiliary Electrical Outlet (Power Outlet) ..........59
Front Air Bag .............................................216 Vehicle.........................................................10 Axle Fluid....................................................... 324
If Deployment Occurs ................................223 Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) ................. 280, 323 Axle Lubrication ............................................ 324
Knee Impact Bolsters ................................219 Disposal ................................................... 281
Maintaining Your Air Bag System ..............227 Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) ...................... 187 B
Maintenance .............................................227 Anti-Lock Warning Light ...................................92 Battery ................................................... 90, 272
Redundant Air Bag Warning Light .............214 Arming System Charging System Light .................................90
Side Air Bags .............................................220 Security Alarm .............................................21 Keyless Key Fob Replacement ....................15
Transporting Pets ......................................240 Assist, Hill Start............................................. 193 Battery Saver Feature ......................................88
Air Bag Light ........................................ 213, 241 Audio Systems (Radio) .................................. 164 Belts, Seat .................................................... 241
Air Cleaner, Engine Auto Down Power Windows .............................62 Blind Spot Monitoring ................................... 194
(Engine Air Cleaner Filter) ..............................274 Auto Hold ...................................................... 105 Body Mechanism Lubrication ........................ 275
Air Conditioner Maintenance .........................274 Automatic Dimming Mirror ...............................37 B-Pillar Location ............................................ 303
Air Conditioner Refrigerant .................. 274, 275 Automatic Door Locks ......................................25 Brake Assist System ..................................... 188
Air Conditioner System ..................................274 Automatic Headlights.......................................45 Brake Control System, Electronic .................. 188 11
Air Conditioning Filter .............................57, 275 Automatic High Beams ....................................45 Brake Fluid .................................................... 324
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 330
330
Brake System ...................................... 282, 319 Check Engine Light Contract, Service ........................................... 326
Anti-Lock (ABS) ..........................................319 (Malfunction Indicator Light) ............................99 Cooling Pressure Cap (Radiator Cap) ............ 281
Fluid Check ..................................... 282, 324 Checking Your Vehicle For Safety ................. 240 Cooling System ............................................. 279
Master Cylinder .........................................282 Checks, Safety .............................................. 240 Adding Coolant (Antifreeze) ...................... 280
Parking ......................................................103 Child Restraint .............................................. 228 Coolant Level ................................... 280, 281
Warning Light .............................................. 90 Child Restraints Cooling Capacity ....................................... 323
Brake/Transmission Interlock .......................107 Booster Seats ........................................... 231 Disposal Of Used Coolant ......................... 281
Brightness, Interior Lights......................... 46, 47 Child Seat Installation .............................. 239 Drain, Flush, And Refill ............................. 280
Bulb Replacement .........................................291 How To Stow An unused ALR Seat Belt .... 236 Inspection ................................................. 281
Bulbs, Light....................................................242 Infant And Child Restraints....................... 230 Points To Remember ................................ 281
Lower Anchors And Tethers Pressure Cap ............................................ 281
C For Children ......................................... 233 Radiator Cap............................................. 281
Camera, Rear ...................................... 148, 150 Older Children And Child Restraints ......... 230 Selection Of Coolant (Antifreeze) ..... 280, 323
Capacities, Fuel .............................................323 Seating Positions ...................................... 232 Corrosion Protection ..................................... 315
Caps, Filler Child Safety Locks ...........................................25 Cruise Control (Speed Control) ...................... 116
Fuel ...........................................................152 Clean Air Gasoline......................................... 320 Cruise Light ...............................................97, 98
Oil (Engine) ................................................271 Cleaning Customer Assistance .................................... 325
Radiator (Coolant Pressure) ......................281 Wheels ..................................................... 315 Cybersecurity ................................................ 164
Car Washes ...................................................316 Windshield Wiper Blades.......................... 275
Carbon Monoxide Warning ............................243 Climate Control ................................................50 D
Cargo Area Cover ............................................. 70 Automatic ....................................................50 Daytime Running Lights ............................43, 44
Cargo Load Floor ............................................. 70 Manual ........................................................53 Defroster, Windshield ................................... 241
Cargo Tie-Downs ....................................... 70, 71 Coin Holder ......................................................58 Dimmer Switch
Cellular Phone ...............................................186 Cold Weather Operation ............................... 101 Headlight ..............................................43, 44
Certification Label .........................................153 Compact Spare Tire ...................................... 310 Dipsticks
Chains, Tire....................................................311 Connector Oil (Engine) ............................................... 272
Change Oil Indicator ........................................ 80 Universal Consumer Interface (UCI).............58 Disabled Vehicle Towing ............................... 264
Changing A Flat Tire .......................................247 Console ............................................................58 Disposal
Chart, Tire Sizing............................................299 Floor ............................................................58 Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) ...................... 281
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 331
331
332
333
Key Fob Programming Brake Warning .............................................90 Low Coolant Level ........................................93
(Remote Keyless Entry) ................................... 16 Bulb Replacement .................................... 291 Low Fuel ......................................................93
Keyless Enter 'n Go™ ................................ 14, 23 Cruise ................................................... 97, 98 Low Washer Fluid ........................................93
Keys................................................................. 14 Daytime Running ..................................43, 44 Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) ..........93
Dimmer Switch, Headlight .................... 43, 44 Oil Pressure .................................................91
L Door Open ...................................................90 Oil Temperature ...........................................92
Lane Change And Turn Signals ................. 43, 46 Drowsiness Detected ..................................91 Park .............................................................96
Lane Change Assist .................................. 43, 46 Electric Power Steering Fault.......................91 Passing .................................................43, 45
Lane Management System ............................145 Electronic Park Brake ..................................93 Seat Belt Reminder .....................................92
LaneSense ...................................................... 96 Electronic Stability Control...........................93 Security Alarm .............................................92
Lap/Shoulder Belts .......................................206 Electronic Throttle Control ...........................91 Service ...................................................... 291
Latches ..........................................................242 Engine Temperature ....................................91 Service 4WD ................................................94
Hood ........................................................... 66 Exterior ..................................................... 242 Service Forward Collision Warning...............94
Leaks, Fluid ...................................................242 Fog .......................................................46, 96 Service Stop Start ........................................94
Life Of Tires ...................................................308 Forward Collision Warning ...........................96 Stop Start Active ..........................................97
Liftgate ..................................................... 66, 67 Fuel Cutoff ...................................................93 Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPMS) ....... 94, 201
Hands-Free.................................................. 69 Headlight Switch..........................................44 Towing Hook Breakdown .............................95
Liftgate Window Wiper/Washer ....................... 49 Headlights ............................................ 43, 44 Traction Control ........................................ 191
Light Bulbs .....................................................242 High Beam ............................................ 44, 97 Transmission Fault ......................................92
Lights .............................................................242 High Beam/Low Beam Select ............... 43, 44 Transmission Temperature ..........................92
4WD Lock .................................................... 96 Hill Descent Control .....................................97 Turn Signals ......................... 43, 46, 97, 242
4WD Low ..................................................... 96 Hill Descent Control Indicator ................... 191 Vanity Mirror ................................................38
Active Speed Limiter Fault........................... 96 Hood Open ..................................................91 Load Floor, Cargo .............................................70
Air Bag .......................................89, 213, 241 Immobilizer Fail VPS Electrical Alarm ..........96 Loading Vehicle ............................................. 153
Anti Lock Brake System............................... 92 Instrument Cluster................................ 43, 44 Tires .......................................................... 303
Automatic Headlights .................................. 45 Intensity Control ................................... 46, 47 Locks
Automatic High Beam.................................. 97 Interior .........................................................46 Auto Unlock .................................................25
Battery Charge ............................................ 90 LaneSense .................................... 93, 96, 97 Child Protection ...........................................25 11
Battery Saver............................................... 46 Liftgate Open ...............................................91 Power Door ..................................................23
Brake Assist Warning ................................191 Lights On Reminder .............................. 43, 45 Low Tire Pressure System ............................. 201
22_MP_OM_EN_USC_t.book Page 334
334
335
336
337
11
This Owner’s Manual illustrates and describes the operation of features and equipment that are either standard or optional on this The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe operation of the vehicle. Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control,
vehicle. This manual may also include a description of features and equipment that are no longer available or were not ordered on resulting in an accident and personal injury. FCA US LLC strongly recommends that the driver use extreme caution when using any device
this vehicle. Please disregard any features and equipment described in this manual that are not on this vehicle. FCA US LLC reserves the or feature that may take their attention off the road. Use of any electrical devices, such as cellular telephones, computers, portable radios,
right to make changes in design and specifications, and/or make additions to or improvements to its products without imposing any vehicle navigation or other devices, by the driver while the vehicle is moving is dangerous and could lead to a serious accident. Texting
obligation upon itself to install them on products previously manufactured. while driving is also dangerous and should never be done while the vehicle is moving. If you find yourself unable to devote your full
With respect to any vehicles sold in Canada, the name FCA US LLC shall be deemed to be deleted and the name FCA Canada Inc. attention to vehicle operation, pull off the road to a safe location and stop your vehicle. Some states or provinces prohibit the use of
used in substitution therefore. cellular telephones or texting while driving. It is always the driver’s responsibility to comply with all local laws.
This Owner’s Manual is intended to familiarize you with the important features of your vehicle. Your most up-to-date Owner’s Manual, This Owner’s Manual has been prepared to help you get acquainted with your new Jeep® brand vehicle and to provide a convenient
Navigation/Uconnect manuals and Warranty Booklet can be found by visiting the website on the back cover. reference source for common questions.
U.S. Residents: If you are the first registered retail owner of your vehicle, you may obtain a complimentary printed copy of the Warranty Not all features shown in this manual may apply to your vehicle. For additional information, visit mopar.com/om (U.S.), owners.mopar.ca
Booklet by calling 1-877-426-5337 or by contacting your dealer. Replacement kits can be purchased by visiting www.techauthority.com. (Canada) or your local Jeep® brand dealer.
Canadian Residents: If you are the first registered retail owner of your vehicle, you may obtain a complimentary printed copy of the
Warranty Booklet or purchase a replacement kit by calling 1-800-387-1143 or by contacting your dealer.
DRIVING AND ALCOHOL
Drunk driving is one of the most frequent causes of accidents. Your driving ability can be seriously impaired with blood alcohol levels
WARNING: Operating, servicing and maintaining a passenger vehicle or off-highway far below the legal minimum. If you are drinking, don’t drive. Ride with a designated non-drinking driver, call a cab, a rideshare, a friend
motor vehicle can expose you to chemicals including engine exhaust, carbon monoxide, or use public transportation.
phthalates, and lead, which are known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth
defects or other reproductive harm. To minimize exposure, avoid breathing exhaust,
do not idle the engine except as necessary, service your vehicle in a well-ventilated area WARNING
and wear gloves or wash your hands frequently when servicing your vehicle. For more Driving after drinking can lead to an accident. Your perceptions are less sharp, your reflexes are slower and your judgment is impaired
information go to www.P65Warnings.ca.gov/passenger-vehicle. when you have been drinking. Never drink and then drive.
2 02 2 COMPASS
Whether it’s providing information about specific product features, taking a tour through your vehicle’s heritage, knowing what
steps to take following an accident or scheduling your next appointment, we know you’ll find the app an important extension of
your Jeep® brand vehicle. Simply download the app, select your make and model and enjoy the ride. To get this app, go directly
to the App Store® or Google Play® Store and enter the search keyword “JEEP” (U.S. residents only). OW NE R’ S M ANUAL
2 02 2 CO M PASS
U. S. Canada
mopar.com/om owners.mopar.ca
©2021 FCA US LLC. All Rights Reserved. Tous droits réservés. Jeep is a registered trademark of FCA US LLC. Jeep est une Second Edition
marque déposée de FCA US LLC. App Store is a registered trademark of Apple Inc. Google Play Store is a registered trademark of Google. 22_MP_OM_EN_USC
Note: This service is not intended for secure transactions such as banking, social media, email, or purchasing. Use at your own risk. We assume no liability whatsoever for broken pages.
Alternative Proxies: